blob: cfbcc5cd6b6715d2020fe9dafe9abdf85a1dc213 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau71f95fa2020-01-22 10:34:58 +01007 2020/01/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100608 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200609 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200611 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200612 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100614 - presetenv
615 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - uid
617 - ulimit-n
618 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200619 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100620 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200621 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-options
625 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-server-options
628 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100629 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200672 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200673 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200674 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100675 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200676 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200677 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100678 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100679 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100680 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.session-timeout
682 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200683 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100684 - tune.maxaccept
685 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200686 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200687 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200688 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100689 - tune.rcvbuf.client
690 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100691 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200692 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.sndbuf.client
694 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100695 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100696 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200697 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100698 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200699 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200700 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100701 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200702 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100703 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200704 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
705 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
706 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100707 - tune.zlib.memlevel
708 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710 * Debugging
711 - debug
712 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713
714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716------------------------------------
717
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200718ca-base <dir>
719 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200720 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
721 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723chroot <jail dir>
724 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
725 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
726 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
727 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
728 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100729 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100730
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
732 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
733 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
734 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
735 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
736 set. These sets have the format
737
738 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
739
740 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100741 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
743 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100744 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
745 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100747 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
751 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
752 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
753 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100754
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100755 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
756 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
757 on the machine's word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
761 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
762 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
763 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
764 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
765 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100766
767 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
769
770 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
771 # first 4 CPUs
772
773 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
774 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
775 # word size.
776
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100777 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100779 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
780 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
781 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
782
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
784 # and so on.
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100789 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100790 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
791 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
792 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
793
794 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
795 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
796 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
797
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100798 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
799 # and a thread range.
800 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
803
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200804crt-base <dir>
805 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100806 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
807 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200808
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200809daemon
810 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
811 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100812 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
813 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200815deviceatlas-json-file <path>
816 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100817 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200818
819deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100820 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
822
823deviceatlas-separator <char>
824 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
825 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
826
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100827deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200828 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
829 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
830 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100831
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900832external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100833 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
834 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100835 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
836 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
837 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
838 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
839 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841gid <number>
842 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
843 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
844 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100845 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
846 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100848
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100849group <group name>
850 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
851 See also "gid" and "user".
852
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100853hard-stop-after <time>
854 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
855
856 Arguments :
857 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
858 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
859 SIGUSR1 signal.
860
861 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
862 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
863 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
864
865 Example:
866 global
867 hard-stop-after 30s
868
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200869h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
870 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
871 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
872 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
873 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
874 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
875 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
876 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
877 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
878 specified in a proxy.
879
880 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
881 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
882 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
883 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
884 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
885 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
886 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
887
888 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
889 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
890 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
891 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
892 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
893
894 Example:
895 global
896 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
897
898 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
899 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
900
901h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
902 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
903 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
904 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
905 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
906 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
907 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
908 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
909 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
910
911 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
912 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
913 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
914
915 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
916 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
917
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100918insecure-fork-wanted
919 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
920 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
921 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
922 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
923 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
924 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
925 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
926 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
927 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
928 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
929 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
930 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
931 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
932 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
933 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
934 disable it.
935
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100936insecure-setuid-wanted
937 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
938 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
939 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
940 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
941 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
942 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
943 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
944 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
945 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
946 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
947 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
948 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
949 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
950 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
951
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200952log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
953 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100954 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100955 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100956 configured with "log global".
957
958 <address> can be one of:
959
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100960 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100961 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
962 port).
963
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100964 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
965 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
966 port).
967
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100968 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100969 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
970 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100972
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100973 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
974 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
975 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
976 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
977 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
978 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
979 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
980 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
981 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
982 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
983 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
984 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
985 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
986 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100987 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
988 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100989
990 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
991 "fd@2", see above.
992
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200993 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
994 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
995 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
996 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
997 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
998
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200999 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1000 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001001
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001002 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1003 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1004 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1005 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1006 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1007 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1008 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1009 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1010 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1011 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001012 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1013 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001014
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001015 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1016 one of the following :
1017
1018 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1019 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1020
1021 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1022 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1023
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001024 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1025 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1026 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1027 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1028 logger consumes.
1029
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001030 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1031 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1032 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1033 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1034
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001035 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1036 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1037 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1038 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1039 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1040
1041 <sample_size>
1042 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1043 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1044 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1045 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1046 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1047
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001048 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001050 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1051 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1052 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1053
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001054 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1055 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1056 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1057 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058
1059 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001060 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1061 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1062 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1063 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1064 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1065 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001067 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001069log-send-hostname [<string>]
1070 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1071 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1072 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1073 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1074 the logs.
1075
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001076log-tag <string>
1077 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1078 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1079 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001080 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001081
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001082lua-load <file>
1083 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1084 used multiple times.
1085
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001086lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1087 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1088 variable.
1089 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1090 to "path".
1091
1092 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1093 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1094 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1095 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1096 will be checked earlier.
1097
1098 As an example by specifying the following path:
1099
1100 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1101 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1102
1103 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1104 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1105 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1106 paths if that does not exist either.
1107
1108 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1109 documentation.
1110
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001111master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001112 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1113 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1114 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001115 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001116 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1117 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001118 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1119 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1120 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1121 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1122 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001123
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001124 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001125
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001126mworker-max-reloads <number>
1127 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001128 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001129 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1130 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1131 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133nbproc <number>
1134 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1135 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1136 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001137 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1138 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001139 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1140 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001142nbthread <number>
1143 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001144 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1145 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1146 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1147 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1148 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001149 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1150 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1151 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1152 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1153 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1154 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1155 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001156
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001158 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1160 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1161
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001162presetenv <name> <value>
1163 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1164 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1165 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1166 and "unsetenv".
1167
1168resetenv [<name> ...]
1169 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1170 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1171 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1172 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1173 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1174 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1175 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1176 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1177
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001178stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001179 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1180 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1181 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1182 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1183 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1184 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001185 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001186 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1187 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1188 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1189 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001190
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001191server-state-base <directory>
1192 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001193 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1194 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001195
1196server-state-file <file>
1197 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1198 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1199 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1200 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1201 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1202 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1203 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1204 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001205 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1206 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001207
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001208setenv <name> <value>
1209 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1210 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1211 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1212 and "unsetenv".
1213
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001214set-dumpable
1215 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001216 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1217 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1218 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1219 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1220 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1221 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1222 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1223 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1224 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1225 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1226 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1227 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1228 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1229 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1230 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1231 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1232 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001234ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1235 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1236 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001237 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001238 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001239 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1240 information and recommendations see e.g.
1241 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1242 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1243 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1244 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001245
1246ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1248 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1249 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1250 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1251 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001252 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1253 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1254 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001255 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001256
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001257ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1259 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1260 keyword to see available options.
1261
1262 Example:
1263 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001264 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001265
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001266ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1268 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001269 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001270 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1272 information and recommendations see e.g.
1273 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1274 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1275 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1276 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1277 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001278
1279ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1281 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1282 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1283 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1284 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001285 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1286 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1287 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1288 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001289
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1292 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1293 keyword to see available options.
1294
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001295ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1297 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1298 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001299 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001300 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001301 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1302 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1303 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1304 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001305 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1306 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1307 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1308
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001309ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer>*
1310 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1311 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1312
1313 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1314 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1315 optimize the startup time.
1316
1317 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1318 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1319 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1320
1321 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
1322 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer.
1323
1324 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1325 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1326 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1327 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1328 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1329 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
1330 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specifiy both the ECDSA
1331 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1332
1333 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1334
1335 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1336
1337 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1338 not provided in the PEM file.
1339
1340 The default behavior is "all".
1341
1342 Example:
1343 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1344 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1345 ssl-load-extra-files none
1346
1347 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1348
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001349ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1350 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1351 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1352 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1353
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001354stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1355 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1356 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1357 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001358 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001359 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001360
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001361 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1362 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1363 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001364
1365stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1366 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1367 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001368 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001369
1370stats maxconn <connections>
1371 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1372 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1373
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001374uid <number>
1375 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1376 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1377 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1378 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1379
1380ulimit-n <number>
1381 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1382 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1383 option.
1384
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001385unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1386 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1387
1388 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1389 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1390 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1391 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1392 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1393 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1394 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1395 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1396 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1397 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1398
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001399unsetenv [<name> ...]
1400 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1401 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1402 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1403 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1404 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1405 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1406 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1407
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001408user <user name>
1409 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1410 See also "uid" and "group".
1411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001412node <name>
1413 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1414
1415 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1416 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1417 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1418 traffic.
1419
1420description <text>
1421 Add a text that describes the instance.
1422
1423 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1424 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1425 "<" and ">" characters.
1426
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100142751degrees-data-file <file path>
1428 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001429 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001430
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001431 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001432 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1433
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000143451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001435 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1436 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1437 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1438
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001439 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001440 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1441
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200144251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001443 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1444 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1445
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001446 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1447 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1448
144951degrees-cache-size <number>
1450 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1451 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1452 By default, this cache is disabled.
1453
1454 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001455 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1456
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001457wurfl-data-file <file path>
1458 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1459 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1460
1461 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1462 with USE_WURFL=1.
1463
1464wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1465 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1466 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1467 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1468
1469 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1470
1471 Valid WURFL properties are:
1472 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1473
1474 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1475 device.
1476
1477 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1478 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1479
1480 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1481 particular web request.
1482
1483 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1484 used Libwurfl API version.
1485
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001486 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1487 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1488
1489 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1490 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1491
1492 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1493
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001494 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1495 with USE_WURFL=1.
1496
1497wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1498 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1499 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1500
1501 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1502 with USE_WURFL=1.
1503
1504wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1505 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1506 thus before the chroot.
1507
1508 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1509 with USE_WURFL=1.
1510
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001511wurfl-cache-size <size>
1512 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1513 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001514 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001515 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001516
1517 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1518 with USE_WURFL=1.
1519
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001520strict-limits
1521 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1522 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1523 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1524 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1525 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1526 keyword.
1527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015283.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529-----------------------
1530
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001531busy-polling
1532 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1533 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1534 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1535 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1536 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1537 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1538 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1539 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1540 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1541 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1542 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1543 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1544 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1545 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1546 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1547 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1548 "poll" pollers.
1549
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001550 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1551 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1552 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1553
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001554max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1555 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1556 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1557 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1558 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1559 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1560 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1561 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1562 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001564maxconn <number>
1565 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1566 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1567 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001568 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1569 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1570 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1571 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001572 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1573 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1574 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1575 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1576 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1577 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001578
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001579maxconnrate <number>
1580 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1581 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1582 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1583 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1584 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1585 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1586 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1587 fairness.
1588
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001589maxcomprate <number>
1590 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001591 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001592 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1593 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1594 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001595 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001596 default value.
1597
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001598maxcompcpuusage <number>
1599 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1600 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1601 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1602 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1603 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1604 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1605 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1606 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1607
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001608maxpipes <number>
1609 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1610 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1611 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1612 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1613 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1614 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1615
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001616maxsessrate <number>
1617 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1618 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1619 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1620 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1621 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1622 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1623 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1624 fairness.
1625
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001626maxsslconn <number>
1627 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1628 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1629 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1630 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1631 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1632 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1633 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001634 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1635 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1636 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1637 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1638 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1639 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1640 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001641
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001642maxsslrate <number>
1643 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1644 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1645 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1646 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1647 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1648 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1649 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1650 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1651 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1652 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1653
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001654maxzlibmem <number>
1655 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1656 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1657 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001658 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1659 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1660 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001662noepoll
1663 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1664 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001665 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001666
1667nokqueue
1668 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1669 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1670 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1671
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001672noevports
1673 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1674 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1675 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1676 also "nopoll".
1677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001678nopoll
1679 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1680 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001682 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1683 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001684
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001685nosplice
1686 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001688 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001689 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001690 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1691 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1692 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1693 "option splice-response".
1694
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001695nogetaddrinfo
1696 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1697 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1698
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001699noreuseport
1700 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1701 command line argument "-dR".
1702
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001703profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1704 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1705 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1706 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1707 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001708 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001709 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1710 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1711 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1712 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1713
1714 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1715 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1716 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1717 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1718 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001719 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1720 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1721 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1722 CLI.
1723
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001724spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001725 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1726 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1727 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1728 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1729 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1730 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001731
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001732ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001733 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001734 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001735 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1736 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1737 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1738 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1739 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1741 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001742 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1743 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1744 openssl configuration file uses:
1745 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1746
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001747ssl-mode-async
1748 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001749 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001750 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1751 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1752 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001753 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001754 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001755
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001756tune.buffers.limit <number>
1757 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1758 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1759 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1760 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1761 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001762 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001763 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1764 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1765 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1766 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1767 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1768 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1769 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1770 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1771 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1772
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001773tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1774 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1775 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1776 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1777 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1778
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001779tune.bufsize <number>
1780 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1781 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1782 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1783 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1784 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1785 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1786 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001787 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1788 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1789 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001790 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001791 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1792 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1793 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001794
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001795tune.chksize <number>
1796 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1797 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1798 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1799 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1800 checks whenever possible.
1801
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001802tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1803 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1804 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1805 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1806 this value. The default value is 1.
1807
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001808tune.fail-alloc
1809 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1810 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1811 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1812 gracefully.
1813
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001814tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1815 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1816 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1817 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1818 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1819 change it.
1820
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001821tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1822 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001823 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1824 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001825 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1826 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1827 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1828 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1829 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1830
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001831tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1832 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1833 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1834 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1835 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1836 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1837 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1838 recommended not to change this value.
1839
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001840tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1841 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1842 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1843 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1844 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1845 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1846 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1847 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1848
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001849tune.http.cookielen <number>
1850 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1851 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1852 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1853 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1854 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1855 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1856 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1857 to change this value.
1858
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001859tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001860 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1861 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001862 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001863 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001864 configuration directives too.
1865 The default value is 1024.
1866
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001867tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1868 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1869 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1870 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1871 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1872 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1873 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001874 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1875 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1876 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001877
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001878tune.idletimer <timeout>
1879 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1880 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1881 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1882 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1883 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1884 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001885 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001886 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001887 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1888
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001889tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1890 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1891 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1892 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1893 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1894 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1895 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1896 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1897 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1898 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1899
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001900tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1901 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001902 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001903 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1904 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001905 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001906 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1907 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1908
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001909tune.lua.maxmem
1910 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1911 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1912 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1913 memory.
1914
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001915tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1916 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001917 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1918 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001919 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001920
1921tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1922 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1923 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1924 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1925 check servers.
1926
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001927tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1928 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1929 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1930 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001931 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001932
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001933tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001934 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1935 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1936 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1937 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1938 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1939 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1940 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1941 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1942 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1943 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001944
1945tune.maxpollevents <number>
1946 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1947 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1948 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1949 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1950 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1951
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001952tune.maxrewrite <number>
1953 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1954 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1955 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1956 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1957 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1958 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1959 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1960 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1961 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1962 bufsize.
1963
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001964tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1965 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1966 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1967 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1968 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1969 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1970 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1971 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1972 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1973 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001974 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1975 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001976 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1977 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1978 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1979 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1980 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1981 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1982 setting this parameter to 0.
1983
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001984tune.pipesize <number>
1985 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1986 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1987 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1988 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1989 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1990 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1991
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001992tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1993 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1994 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1995 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1996 default is 20.
1997
1998tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1999 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2000 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2001 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2002 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2003 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2004 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002005 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002006
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002007tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2008tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2009 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2010 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2011 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002012 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002013 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002014 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2015 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2016
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002017tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002018 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002019 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2020 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2021 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2022 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2023
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002024tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002025 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002026 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2027 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2028
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002029tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2030tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2031 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2032 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2033 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002034 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002035 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002036 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2037 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2038 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2039 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2040 notifying haproxy again.
2041
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002042tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002043 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2044 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2045 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002046 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002047 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002048 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002049 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2050 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2051 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002052 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2053 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002054
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002055tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002056 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002057 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2058 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2059 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2060 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2061 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2062
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002063tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2064 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002065 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002066 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2067 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2068 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2069 being used for too long.
2070
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002071tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2072 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2073 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2074 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2075 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2076 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2077 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2078 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2079 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2080 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2081 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002082 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002083 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002084
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002085tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2086 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2087 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2088 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2089 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2090 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2091 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2092 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002093 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2094 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002095
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002096tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2097 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2098 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2099 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2100 1000 entries.
2101
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002102tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2103 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2104 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2105 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2106
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002107tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002108tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002109tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2110tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2111tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002112 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2113 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2114 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2115 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2116 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2117 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2118 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2119 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002120
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002121 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2122 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2123 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2124 all available space is consumed.
2125 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2126 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2127 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002128
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002129tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2130 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002131 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002132 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002133 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002134 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2135
2136tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2137 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2138 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002139 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2140 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021423.3. Debugging
2143--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002144
2145debug
2146 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2147 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2148 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2149 system startup.
2150
2151quiet
2152 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2153 line argument "-q".
2154
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021563.4. Userlists
2157--------------
2158It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2159http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2160it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2161
2162userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002163 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002164 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2165
2166group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002167 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002168 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2169 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2170
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002171user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2172 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002173 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2174 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002175 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2176 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2177 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2178 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002179
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002180 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2181 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2182 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2183 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2184 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2185 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2186 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2187 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2188 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002189
2190 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002191 userlist L1
2192 group G1 users tiger,scott
2193 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002194
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002195 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2196 user scott insecure-password elgato
2197 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002199 userlist L2
2200 group G1
2201 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002202
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002203 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2204 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2205 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002206
2207 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002208
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002209
22103.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002211----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002212It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2213several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2214instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2215values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2216automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2217In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2218using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2219tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2220reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2221Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2222that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2223each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002224
2225peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002226 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002227 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2228
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002229bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2230 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2231 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2232
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002233disabled
2234 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2235 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2236 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2237
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002238default-bind [param*]
2239 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2240
2241default-server [param*]
2242 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2243
2244 Arguments:
2245 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2246 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2247 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2248 details.
2249
2250
2251 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2252
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002253enable
2254 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2255
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002256log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2257 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2258 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2259 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2260 more details.
2261
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002262peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002263 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2264 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2265 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2266 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2267 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2268 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2269
2270 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2271 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2272
2273 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2274 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2275 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2276 across all peers.
2277
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002278 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2279 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002280
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002281 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2282 "server" keyword explanation below).
2283
2284server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002285 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002286 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2287 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2288 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2289 of this "peers" section).
2290 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2291
2292
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002293 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002294 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002295 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002296 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2297 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2298 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002299
2300 backend mybackend
2301 mode tcp
2302 balance roundrobin
2303 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2304 stick on src
2305
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002306 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2307 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309 Example:
2310 peers mypeers
2311 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2312 default-server ssl verify none
2313 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2314 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002315
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002316
2317table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2318 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2319
2320 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2321 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002322 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002323 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2324 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2325 "stick-table" keyword).
2326
2327 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2328 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2329 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2330 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2331 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2332 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2333 of the stick-table name as follows:
2334
2335 peers mypeers
2336 peer A ...
2337 peer B ...
2338 table t1 ...
2339
2340 frontend fe1
2341 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2342
2343 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2344 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2345
2346 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2347 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2348 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2349 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2350 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2351 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2352 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2353
2354 peers mypeers
2355 peer A ...
2356 peer B ...
2357 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2358
2359 backend t1
2360 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2361
2362 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2363 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2364 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2365
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023663.6. Mailers
2367------------
2368It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2369If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2370in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2371
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002372mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002373 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2374 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2375
2376mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2377 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2378
2379 Example:
2380 mailers mymailers
2381 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2382 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2383
2384 backend mybackend
2385 mode tcp
2386 balance roundrobin
2387
2388 email-alert mailers mymailers
2389 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2390 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2391
2392 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2393 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2394
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002395timeout mail <time>
2396 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2397 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2398 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2399 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2400
2401 Example:
2402 mailers mymailers
2403 timeout mail 20s
2404 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002405
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024063.7. Programs
2407-------------
2408In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2409master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2410managed the same way as the workers.
2411
2412During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2413sequence as a worker:
2414
2415 - the master is re-executed
2416 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2417 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2418 instance of the program
2419
2420During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2421
2422program <name>
2423 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2424 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2425 the management guide).
2426
2427command <command> [arguments*]
2428 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2429 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2430 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2431 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2432
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002433user <user name>
2434 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2435 See also "group".
2436
2437group <group name>
2438 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2439 See also "user".
2440
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002441option start-on-reload
2442no option start-on-reload
2443 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2444 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2445 program section.
2446
2447
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024483.8. HTTP-errors
2449----------------
2450
2451It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2452imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2453several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2454
2455http-errors <name>
2456 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2457 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2458
2459errorfile <code> <file>
2460 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2461
2462 Arguments :
2463 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2464 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2465 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2466
2467 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2468 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2469 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2470 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2471 before any chroot is performed.
2472
2473 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2474
2475 Example:
2476 http-errors website-1
2477 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2478 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2479 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2480
2481 http-errors website-2
2482 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2483 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2484 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2485
2486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002488----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002490Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002491 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002492 - frontend <name>
2493 - backend <name>
2494 - listen <name>
2495
2496A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2497its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2498section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002500
2501A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2502connections.
2503
2504A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2505to forward incoming connections.
2506
2507A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2508parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2509
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2511'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2512case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2513
2514Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2515logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2516proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2517However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2518name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2519
2520Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2521and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002522bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2524modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2525arbitrary criteria.
2526
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002527In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2528a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002529the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002530
2531 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2532 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2533 between responses and new requests.
2534
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002535 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2536 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2537 client-facing connection remains open.
2538
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002539 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2540 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002541
2542The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2543frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2544following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002545weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002546
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002547 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002548
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002549 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2550 ----+-----+-----+----
2551 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2552 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002553 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2554 ----+-----+-----+----
2555 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2560--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002562The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2563limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2564they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2565limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002566marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002567option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002568and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2569with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2570specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002572
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002573 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2574------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2575acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002576backlog X X X -
2577balance X - X X
2578bind - X X -
2579bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580capture cookie - X X -
2581capture request header - X X -
2582capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002583compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002584cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002585declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586default-server X - X X
2587default_backend X X X -
2588description - X X X
2589disabled X X X X
2590dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002591email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002592email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002593email-alert mailers X X X X
2594email-alert myhostname X X X X
2595email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002596enabled X X X X
2597errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002598errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002599errorloc X X X X
2600errorloc302 X X X X
2601-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2602errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002603force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002604filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002605fullconn X - X X
2606grace X X X X
2607hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002608http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002609http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002610http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002611http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002612http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002613http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002614http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002615http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002616id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002617ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002618load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002619log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002620log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002621log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002622log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002623max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002624maxconn X X X -
2625mode X X X X
2626monitor fail - X X -
2627monitor-net X X X -
2628monitor-uri X X X -
2629option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2630option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2631option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2632option allbackups (*) X - X X
2633option checkcache (*) X - X X
2634option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2635option contstats (*) X X X -
2636option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2637option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002638-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2639option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002640option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2641option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002642option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002643option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002644option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002645option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002646option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002647option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2648option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2649option httpchk X - X X
2650option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002651option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002653option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002654option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002655option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002656option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2657option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2658option logasap (*) X X X -
2659option mysql-check X - X X
2660option nolinger (*) X X X X
2661option originalto X X X X
2662option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002663option pgsql-check X - X X
2664option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002665option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002666option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002667option smtpchk X - X X
2668option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2669option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2670option splice-request (*) X X X X
2671option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002672option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002673option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2674option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2675-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002676option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002677option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2678option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2679option tcpka X X X X
2680option tcplog X X X X
2681option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002682external-check command X - X X
2683external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002684persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2685rate-limit sessions X X X -
2686redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002687-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002688retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002689retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002690server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002691server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002692server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002693source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002694stats admin - X X X
2695stats auth X X X X
2696stats enable X X X X
2697stats hide-version X X X X
2698stats http-request - X X X
2699stats realm X X X X
2700stats refresh X X X X
2701stats scope X X X X
2702stats show-desc X X X X
2703stats show-legends X X X X
2704stats show-node X X X X
2705stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002706-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2707stick match - - X X
2708stick on - - X X
2709stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002710stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002711stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002712tcp-check connect - - X X
2713tcp-check expect - - X X
2714tcp-check send - - X X
2715tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002716tcp-request connection - X X -
2717tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002718tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002719tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002720tcp-response content - - X X
2721tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002722timeout check X - X X
2723timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002724timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002725timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002726timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2727timeout http-request X X X X
2728timeout queue X - X X
2729timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002730timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002731timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002732timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002733transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002734unique-id-format X X X -
2735unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002736use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002737use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002738use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2740 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027434.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2744---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002745
2746This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2747
2748
2749acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2750 Declare or complete an access list.
2751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2752 no | yes | yes | yes
2753 Example:
2754 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2755 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2756 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002758 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759
2760
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002761backlog <conns>
2762 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2764 yes | yes | yes | no
2765 Arguments :
2766 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2767 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002768 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002769
2770 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2771 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2772 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2773 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2774 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2775 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2776 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2777 backlog parameter.
2778
2779 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2780 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2781 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2782
2783 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2784
2785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002786balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002787balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2790 yes | no | yes | yes
2791 Arguments :
2792 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2793 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2794 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2795 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2796
2797 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2798 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2799 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2800 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002801 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002802 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002803 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2804 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2805 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2806 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2807 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2808 it, so that you don't worry.
2809
2810 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2811 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2812 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2813 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2814 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2815 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2816 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2817 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002818
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002819 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2820 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2821 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2822 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2823 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2824 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2825 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2826 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2827
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002828 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002829 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002830 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2831 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002832 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002833 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2834 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2835 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2836 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2837 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002838 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2839 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2840 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2841 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2842 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2843 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2846 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2847 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2848 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2849 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2850 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2851 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2852 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002853 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002854 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002855 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2856 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2857 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002859 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2860 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2861 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2862 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2863 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2864 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2865 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2866 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2867 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2868 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2869 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2870 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002871
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002872 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002873 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2874 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2875 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2876 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2877 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2878 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2879 URIs start with a leading "/".
2880
2881 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2882 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2883 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2884 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2885
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002887 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2888
2889 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002890 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2891 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002892 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2893 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2894 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2895 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002896 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002897 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2898 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002899
2900 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2901 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2902 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2903 server will receive the request.
2904
2905 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2906 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2907 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2908 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2909 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002910 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2911 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2912 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002914 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2915 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2916 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2917 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2918 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002920 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002921 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2922 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2923 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2924
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002925 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2926 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2927 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2928
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002929 random
2930 random(<draws>)
2931 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002932 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2933 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2934 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2935 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002936 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2937 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2938 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2939 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2940 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2941 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2942 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2943 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2944 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2945 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2946 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2947 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2948 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2949 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2950 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2951 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2952 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2953 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2954 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2955 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002956
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002957 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002958 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002959 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2960 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2961 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2962 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2963 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2964 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002965 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002966 used instead.
2967
2968 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2969 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2970 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2971 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2972
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002973 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2974 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2975 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2976
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002977 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002978
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002979 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002980 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2981 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002982
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002983 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2984 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2985 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002987 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002988 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002989 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2990 NTLM relies on.
2991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992 Examples :
2993 balance roundrobin
2994 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002995 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002996 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2997 balance hdr(host)
2998 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002999
3000 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3001 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3002
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003003 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003004 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3005 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3006 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003007 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003008
3009 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3010 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3011 defaults to 16 kB.
3012
3013 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3014 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3015
3016 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3017 Round Robin.
3018
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003019 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003020 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3021 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3022 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3023
3024 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3025
3026 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003027 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003028 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3029 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3030 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003031
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003032 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033
3034
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003035bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3036bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003037 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 no | yes | yes | no
3040 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003041 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3042 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3043 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3044 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003045 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003046 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3047 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3048 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3049 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3050 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3051 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3052 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003053 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3054 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3055 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3056 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3057 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3058 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3059 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003060 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3061 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3062 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003063 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3064 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3065 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3066 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003067 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3068 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3069 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003070
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003071 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3072 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003073 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3074 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3075 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003076 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3077 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3078 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3079 the range.
3080
3081 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3082 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3083 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3084 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3085 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3086 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3087 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003088 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003089 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003091 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003092 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003093 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3094 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3095 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3096 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3097 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3098 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3099
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003100 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3101 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3102 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3103 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3106 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3107 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3108 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3109 in a frontend.
3110
3111 Example :
3112 listen http_proxy
3113 bind :80,:443
3114 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003115 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003117 listen http_https_proxy
3118 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003119 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003120
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003121 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3122 bind ipv6@:80
3123 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3124 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3125
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003126 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003127 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003128
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003129 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3130 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3131 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3132 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3133 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3134
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003135 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003136 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137
3138
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003139bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003140 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3142 yes | yes | yes | yes
3143 Arguments :
3144 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3145 may be used to override a default value.
3146
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003147 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003148 option may be combined with other numbers.
3149
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003150 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003151 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3152 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3153 missing from all processes.
3154
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003155 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003156 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003157 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3158 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3159 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3160 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3161 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003162 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003163
3164 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3165 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3166 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3167 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3168 and 'even' instances.
3169
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003170 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3171 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3172 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3173 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003174
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003175 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3176 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3177
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003178 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3179 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3180 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3181
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003182 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3183 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3184
3185 Example :
3186 listen app_ip1
3187 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003188 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003189
3190 listen app_ip2
3191 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003192 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003193
3194 listen management
3195 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003196 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003197
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003198 listen management
3199 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3200 bind-process 1-4
3201
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003202 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003203
3204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003205capture cookie <name> len <length>
3206 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 no | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3211 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3212 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3213 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003214 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003215
3216 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3217 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3218 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3219 right if it exceeds <length>.
3220
3221 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3222 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3223 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3224 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3225
3226 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3227 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3228 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3229
3230 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3231 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3232 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003233 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3234 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3235 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003236
3237 Example:
3238 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3239
3240 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003241 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003242
3243
3244capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003245 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3247 no | yes | yes | no
3248 Arguments :
3249 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003250 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3252 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3253 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3254
3255 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3256 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3257 it exceeds <length>.
3258
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003259 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3261 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003262 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3263 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3264 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3265 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003266 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003267 environments to find where the request came from.
3268
3269 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3270 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3271 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3272 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003274 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3275 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3276 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3277 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3278 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003279
3280 Example:
3281 capture request header Host len 15
3282 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003283 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003285 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286 about logging.
3287
3288
3289capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003290 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3292 no | yes | yes | no
3293 Arguments :
3294 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003295 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3297 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3298 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3299
3300 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3301 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3302 it exceeds <length>.
3303
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003304 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3306 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3307 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003308 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3309 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3310 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3311 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003312
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003313 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3314 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3315 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3316 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3317 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003318
3319 Example:
3320 capture response header Content-length len 9
3321 capture response header Location len 15
3322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003323 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003324 about logging.
3325
3326
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003327compression algo <algorithm> ...
3328compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003329compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003330 Enable HTTP compression.
3331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3332 yes | yes | yes | yes
3333 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003334 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3335 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3336 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3337
3338 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003339 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3340 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3341 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003342
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003343 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003344 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003345
3346 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3347 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3348 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3349 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3350 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003351 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003352
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003353 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3354 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3355 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3356 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3357 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3358 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3359 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003360 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003361
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003362 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003363 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003364 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3365 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3366 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3367 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3368 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003369
3370 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3371 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3372 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3373 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3374 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003375 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3376 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3377 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3378 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3379 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003380 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3381 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003382
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003383 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003384 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3385 "Accept-Encoding" header
3386 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003387 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003388 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3389 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3390 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3391 "multipart"
3392 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3393 header
3394 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3395 and later
3396 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3397 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003398 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003399
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003400 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003401
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003402 Examples :
3403 compression algo gzip
3404 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003406
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003407cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003408 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3409 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003410 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 yes | no | yes | yes
3414 Arguments :
3415 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3416 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3417 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3418 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3419 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3420 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003421 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003422 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3423 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3424
3425 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3426 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3427 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3428 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3429 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3430 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003431 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3432 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003433 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003434 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3435 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003436
3437 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003438 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003439
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003440 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003441 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003442 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003443 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003444 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3445 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3446 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3447 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3448 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3449 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3450 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003451
3452 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3453 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3454 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3455 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3456 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3457 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3458 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3459 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3460 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003461 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003462 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3463 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3464 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003466 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3467 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3468 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003469 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3470 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3471 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3472 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003473 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3474 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3475 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476
3477 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3478 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3479 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3480 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3481 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3482 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3483 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3484 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3485 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3486
3487 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3488 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3489 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3490 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3491 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3492 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3493 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3494 persistence cookie in the cache.
3495 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3496
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003497 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3498 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3499 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3500 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3501 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003503 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3504 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3505 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3506 they logout.
3507
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003508 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3509 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3510 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3511 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3512
3513 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3514 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3515 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3516 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3517 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3518 this attribute.
3519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003520 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003521 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003522 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3523 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3524 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3525 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3526 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3527 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003528
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003529 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3530 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3531 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3532 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3533 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3534 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3535 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3536 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003537 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003538 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3539 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3540 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3541 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3542 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3543 the site.
3544
3545 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3546 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3547 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3548 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3549 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3550 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3551 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3552 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3553 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3554 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3555 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3556 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3557 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003558 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003559 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3560 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3561
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003562 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3563 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3564 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3565 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3566 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3567 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3568
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003569 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3570 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3571 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3572 repeated.
3573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3575 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3576 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3577 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579 Examples :
3580 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3581 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3582 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003583 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003585 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003587
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003588declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3589 Declares a capture slot.
3590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3591 no | yes | yes | no
3592 Arguments:
3593 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3594
3595 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3596 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3597 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3598 for use in the response.
3599
3600 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003601 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003602 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3603
3604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003605default-server [param*]
3606 Change default options for a server in a backend
3607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3608 yes | no | yes | yes
3609 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003610 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3611 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3612 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3613 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003614
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003615 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003616 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3617
3618 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003619
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621default_backend <backend>
3622 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3624 yes | yes | yes | no
3625 Arguments :
3626 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3627
3628 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3629 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3630 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3631 will catch all undetermined requests.
3632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633 Example :
3634
3635 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3636 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3637 default_backend dynamic
3638
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003639 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003641
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003642description <string>
3643 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 no | yes | yes | yes
3646 Arguments : string
3647
3648 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3649 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3650 it describes.
3651 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3652
3653
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003654disabled
3655 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | yes | yes | yes
3658 Arguments : none
3659
3660 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3661 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3662 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3663 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3664 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3665 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3666 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3667
3668 See also : "enabled"
3669
3670
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003671dispatch <address>:<port>
3672 Set a default server address
3673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003675 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003676
3677 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3678 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3679 during start-up.
3680
3681 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3682 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3683 possible with normal servers.
3684
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003685 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003686 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3687 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3688 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3689 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3690
3691 See also : "server"
3692
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003693
3694dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3695 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3697 yes | no | yes | yes
3698 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3699
3700 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003701 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003702 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3703 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003704 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003705 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003707enabled
3708 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 yes | yes | yes | yes
3711 Arguments : none
3712
3713 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3714 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3715
3716 See also : "disabled"
3717
3718
3719errorfile <code> <file>
3720 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 yes | yes | yes | yes
3723 Arguments :
3724 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003725 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3726 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003727
3728 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003729 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003730 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003731 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3732 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003733
3734 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3735 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3736 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3737
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003738 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3739
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003740 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3741 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3742 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3743 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3744
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003745 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3746 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003747 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003748 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3749 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3750 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003752 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3753 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3754 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003755 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003756 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3757
3758 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3759
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003760 Example :
3761 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003762 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003763 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3764 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3765
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003766
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003767errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3768 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3769 section.
3770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3771 yes | yes | yes | yes
3772 Arguments :
3773 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3774
3775 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3776 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3777 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3778
3779 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3780 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3781 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3782 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3783 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3784 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3785 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3786
3787 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3788 3.8 about http-errors.
3789
3790 Example :
3791 errorfiles generic
3792 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3793
3794
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003795errorloc <code> <url>
3796errorloc302 <code> <url>
3797 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3799 yes | yes | yes | yes
3800 Arguments :
3801 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003802 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3803 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003804
3805 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3806 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3807 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3808 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003809 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003810
3811 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3812 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3813 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3814
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003815 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003817 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3818 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3819 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3820 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003821 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003822 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3823 request.
3824
3825 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3826
3827
3828errorloc303 <code> <url>
3829 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3831 yes | yes | yes | yes
3832 Arguments :
3833 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003834 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3835 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003836
3837 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3838 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3839 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3840 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003841 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003842
3843 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3844 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3845 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3846
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003847 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003849 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3850 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3851 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3852 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003853 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003854
3855 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3856
3857
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003858email-alert from <emailaddr>
3859 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003860 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3862 yes | yes | yes | yes
3863
3864 Arguments :
3865
3866 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3867
3868 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3869 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3870
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003871 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003872 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3873 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003874
3875
3876email-alert level <level>
3877 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3878 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3880 yes | yes | yes | yes
3881
3882 Arguments :
3883
3884 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3885 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3886 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3887
3888 By default level is alert
3889
3890 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3891 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3892 for the proxy.
3893
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003894 Alerts are sent when :
3895
3896 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3897 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3898 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3899 is notice or lower
3900 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3901 and a health check status update occurs
3902
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003903 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3904 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003905 section 3.6 about mailers.
3906
3907
3908email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3909 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 yes | yes | yes | yes
3912
3913 Arguments :
3914
3915 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3916
3917 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3918 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3919
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003920 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3921 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003922
3923
3924email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3925 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3926 mailers.
3927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3928 yes | yes | yes | yes
3929
3930 Arguments :
3931
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003932 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003933
3934 By default the systems hostname is used.
3935
3936 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3937 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3938 for the proxy.
3939
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003940 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3941 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003942
3943
3944email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003945 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003946 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3948 yes | yes | yes | yes
3949
3950 Arguments :
3951
3952 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3953
3954 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3955 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3956
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003957 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003958 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3959
3960
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003961force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3962 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003964 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003965
3966 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3967 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3968 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3969 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3970 marked down for maintenance operations.
3971
3972 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3973 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3974 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3975 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3976 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3977 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3978 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3979 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3980 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3981
3982 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3983 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3984 is used.
3985
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003986 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003987 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003988
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003989
3990filter <name> [param*]
3991 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3993 no | yes | yes | yes
3994 Arguments :
3995 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3996 referenced in section 9.
3997
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003998 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003999 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004000 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4001 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004002
4003 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4004 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4005
4006 Example:
4007 listen
4008 bind *:80
4009
4010 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4011 filter compression
4012 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4013
4014 compression algo gzip
4015 compression offload
4016
4017 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4018
4019 See also : section 9.
4020
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004022fullconn <conns>
4023 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | no | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
4027 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4028 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4029
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004030 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004031 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004032 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004033 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4034 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4035 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4036 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4037 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004038 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004039
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004040 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4041 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004042 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4043 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4044 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004045
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004046 Example :
4047 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4048 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4049 # connections.
4050 backend dynamic
4051 fullconn 10000
4052 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4053 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4054
4055 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4056
4057
4058grace <time>
4059 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004061 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004062 Arguments :
4063 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4064 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4065 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4066
4067 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4068 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004069 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004070 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4071
4072 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4073 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4074 simplify it.
4075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004076
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004077hash-balance-factor <factor>
4078 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4080 yes | no | no | yes
4081 Arguments :
4082 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4083 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004084 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004085
4086 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4087 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4088 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4089 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4090 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4091 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4092 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4093
4094 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4095 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4096 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4097 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4098 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4099
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004100 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4101 consistent hashing mechanism.
4102
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004103 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4104
4105
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004106hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004107 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | no | yes | yes
4110 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004111 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4112 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004113
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004114 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4115 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4116 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4117 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4118 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4119 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4120 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4121 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4122 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4123 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004124
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004125 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4126 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4127 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4128 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4129 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4130 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4131 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4132 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4133 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4134 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4135 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4136 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4137 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004138 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4139 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004140
4141 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4142
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004143 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004144 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4145 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4146 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004147 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4148 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4149 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004150
4151 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4152 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004153 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4154 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4155 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4156 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4157
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004158 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4159 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4160 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4161 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4162 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4163 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4164 parameter.
4165
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004166 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4167 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4168 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4169 used on strings.
4170
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004171 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4172
4173 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4174 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4175 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4176 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4177 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4178 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4179 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4180 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4181 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4182 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4183 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4184 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004185
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004186 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4187 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4188 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004189
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004190 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004191
4192
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004193http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4194 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4195 ones).
4196
4197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4198 no | yes | yes | yes
4199
4200 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4201 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4202 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4203 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4204 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4205 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4206
4207 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4208 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4209 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4210
4211 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4212 below.
4213
4214 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4215 instance.
4216
4217 Example:
4218 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4219 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4220 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4221
4222http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4223
4224 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4225 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4226 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4227 example, or to pass some internal information.
4228 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4229 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4230 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4231
4232http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4233
4234 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4235 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4236
4237http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4238
4239 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4240
4241http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4242 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4243
4244 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4245
4246 Example:
4247 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4248
4249 # applied to:
4250 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4251
4252 # outputs:
4253 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4254
4255 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4256
4257http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4258 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4259
4260 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4261
4262 Example:
4263 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4264
4265 # applied to:
4266 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4267
4268 # outputs:
4269 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4270
4271http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4272
4273 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4274 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4275 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4276
4277http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4278 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4279
4280 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4281 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4282 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4283 fallback.
4284
4285 Example:
4286 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4287 http-response set-status 431
4288 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4289 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4290
4291http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4292
4293 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4294 inline.
4295
4296 Arguments:
4297 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4298 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4299 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4300 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4301 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4302 (request and response)
4303 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4304 processing
4305 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4306 processing
4307 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4308 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4309 and '_'.
4310
4311 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4312 followed by some converters.
4313
4314 Example:
4315 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4316
4317http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4318
4319 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4320 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4321 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4322 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4323 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4324 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
4325 processing.
4326
4327 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4328 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4329 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4330 rules evaluation.
4331
4332http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4333
4334 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4335 details about <var-name>.
4336
4337 Example:
4338 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4339
4340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341http-check disable-on-404
4342 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004344 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004345 Arguments : none
4346
4347 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4348 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4349 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4350 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4351 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4352 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4353 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4354 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004355 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4356 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4357 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4358
4359 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4360
4361
4362http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004363 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004365 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004366 Arguments :
4367 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4368 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004369 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004370 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4371 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4372 details on the supported keywords.
4373
4374 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4375 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4376 with the usual backslash ('\').
4377
4378 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4379 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4380 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4381 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4382 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4383
4384 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004385 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004386 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4387 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4388 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4389
4390 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004391 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004392 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4393 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4394 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4395 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4396
4397 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004398 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004399 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4400 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4401 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4402 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4403 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004404 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004405 trace).
4406
4407 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004409 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4410 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4411 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4412 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4413 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004414 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004415
4416 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4417 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4418 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4419 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4420 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4421 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4422 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4423 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4424
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004425 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4426 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4427 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4428
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004429 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4430 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4431
4432 Examples :
4433 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004434 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004435
4436 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004437 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004438
4439 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004440 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004441
4442 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004443 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004444
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004445 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004446
4447
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004448http-check send-state
4449 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4451 yes | no | yes | yes
4452 Arguments : none
4453
4454 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4455 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4456 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4457 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4458 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4459
4460 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4461 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4462 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4463 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4464 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004465 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4466 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4467 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4468
4469 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4470 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4471 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4472
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004473 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4474 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4475 checked in multiple backends.
4476
4477 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4478 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4479
4480 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4481 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4482 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4483 one fails.
4484
4485 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4486 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4487 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4488
4489 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4490 server's queue.
4491
4492 Example of a header received by the application server :
4493 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4494 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4495
4496 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004498
4499http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004500 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4501
4502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 no | yes | yes | yes
4504
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004505 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4506 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4507 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4508 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4509 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004511 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4512 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004514 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004516 Example:
4517 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4518 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4519 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004521 http-request allow if nagios
4522 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4523 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4524 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004526 Example:
4527 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4528 acl add path /addacl
4529 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004531 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004533 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4534 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536 Example:
4537 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4538 acl setmap path /setmap
4539 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004541 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004543 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4544 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4547 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004550
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004551 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4552 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4553 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4554 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4555 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4556 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4557 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4558 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004562 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4563 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4564 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4565 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4566 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4567 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4568 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4569 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004571http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4574 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004575
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4580 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4581 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4582 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4583 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004584
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004585 Example:
4586 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4587 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004588
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004589http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004590
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004591 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004593http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4594 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004596 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4597 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4598 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4599 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4600 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4601 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4602 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4603 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4604 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4607 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4608 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004609 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4610
4611 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4612 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4613 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4614 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004616http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004618 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4619 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4620 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4621 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4622 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4623 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004627 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004631 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4632 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4633 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4634 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4635 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4636 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004637
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004638http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4639 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4642 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4643 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004644 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4645 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4646 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4647 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4648 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004650
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004651http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4652 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4653 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4654 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4655
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004656http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4657
4658 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4659 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4660 pointed by <resolvers>.
4661 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4662 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4663 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4664 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4665 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4666 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4667 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4668 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4669 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4670 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4671 to 0.0.0.0.
4672
4673 Example:
4674 resolvers mydns
4675 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4676 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4677 timeout retry 1s
4678 hold valid 10s
4679 hold nx 3s
4680 hold other 3s
4681 hold obsolete 0s
4682 accepted_payload_size 8192
4683
4684 frontend fe
4685 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4686 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4687 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4688
4689 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4690 # which mean DNS resolution error
4691 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4692
4693 default_backend be
4694
4695 backend b_503
4696 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4697 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4698 # 503 error page to end users
4699
4700 backend be
4701 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4702 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4703 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4704 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4705 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4706
4707 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4708 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4709
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004710http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4711
4712 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4713 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4714 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4715 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004716 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4717 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004718
4719 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004721http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004723 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4724 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4725 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4726 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4727 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004729http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004731 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4732 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4733 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4734 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004736http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4737 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004738
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004739 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4740 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4741 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4742 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4743 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4744 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004745
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004746 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4747 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4748 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4749 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4750 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004751
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004752 Example:
4753 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4754
4755 # applied to:
4756 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4757
4758 # outputs:
4759 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4760
4761 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004762
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004763 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4764
4765 # applied to:
4766 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004767
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004768 # outputs:
4769 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004770
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004771http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4772 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4773
4774 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4775 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4776 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4777 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4778
4779 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4780 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4781 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4782
4783 Example:
4784 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4785 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4786
4787 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4788 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4789
4790 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4791 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4792 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4793 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4794
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004795http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4796 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4797
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004798 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4799 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4800 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4801 against.
4802
4803 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4804 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4805 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004806
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004807 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4808 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4809 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4810 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4811 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4812 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4813 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4814 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4815 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004816 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4817 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004818
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004819 Example:
4820 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4821 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004822
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004823 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4824 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004826http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4827 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004828
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004829 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4830 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4831 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4832 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004833
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004834 Example:
4835 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004836
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004837 # applied to:
4838 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004839
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004840 # outputs:
4841 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004842
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004843http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4844http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004845
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004846 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4847 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4848 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004849
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004850http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4851 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004852
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004853 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4854 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4855 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4856 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004858http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004860 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4861 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4862 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4863 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4864 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004865
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004866 Arguments:
4867 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4868 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004870 Example:
4871 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4872 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004873
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004874 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4875 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004876
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004877http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004879 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4880 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4881 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004882
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004883 Arguments:
4884 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4885 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004887 Example:
4888 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4889 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004891 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4892 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4893 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004895http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004896
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004897 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4898 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4899 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4900 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4901 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004903 Example:
4904 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4905 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4906 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4907 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4908 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4909 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4910 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4911 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4912 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004914http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004916 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4917 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4918 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4919 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4920 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004921
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004922http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4923 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004925 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4926 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4927 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4928 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4929 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4930 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4931 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4932 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4933 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004935http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004936
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004937 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4938 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4939 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4940 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4941 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4942 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4943 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004945http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004946
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004947 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4948 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4949 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004950
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004951http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004953 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4954 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4955 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4956 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4957 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4958 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4959 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4960 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004962http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004963
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004964 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4965 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4966 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4967 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4968 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4969 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004970
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004971 Example :
4972 # prepend the host name before the path
4973 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004974
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004975http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004977 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4978 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4979 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4980 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4981 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004983http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004985 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4986 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4987 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4988 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4989 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4990 values have higher priority.
4991 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4992 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4993 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4994 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4995 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004997http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004999 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5000 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5001 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5002 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5003 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5004 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5005 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005006
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005007 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005008
5009 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005010 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5011 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005013http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5014 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5015 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5016 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
5017 privacy.
5018
5019 Arguments :
5020 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5021 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005022
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005023 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005024 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5025 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5026
5027 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5028 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5029
5030http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5031
5032 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5033 expression.
5034
5035 Arguments:
5036 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5037 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005038
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005039 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005040 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5041 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5042
5043 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5044 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5045 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5046
5047http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5048
5049 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5050 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5051 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5052 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5053 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5054 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5055 information from the request.
5056
5057 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5058
5059http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5060
5061 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5062 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5063 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5064 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5065 path and the query string.
5066 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5067
5068http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5069
5070 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5071 inline.
5072
5073 Arguments:
5074 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5075 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5076 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5077 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5078 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5079 (request and response)
5080 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5081 processing
5082 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5083 processing
5084 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5085 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5086 and '_'.
5087
5088 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5089 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005090
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005091 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005092 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005094http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5095 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005097 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5098 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5099 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5100 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5101 agent name must be used.
5102
5103 Arguments:
5104 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5105
5106 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5107 configuration.
5108
5109http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5110
5111 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5112 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5113 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5114 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5115 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5116 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5117 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5118 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5119 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5120 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5121 action.
5122 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5123 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5124 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5125 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5126 you fully understand how it works.
5127
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005128http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5129
5130 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5131 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5132 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5133 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5134 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5135 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
5136 processing.
5137
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005138 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005139 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5140 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5141 rules evaluation.
5142
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005143http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5144 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005145
5146 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5147 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5148 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5149 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5150 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5151 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5152 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5153 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5154 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5155 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5156 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005157 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5158 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5159 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5160 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5161 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005162 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5163
5164http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5165http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5166http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5167
5168 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5169 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5170 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5171 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5172 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5173 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5174 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5175 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5176 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5177 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5178 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5179 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5180
5181 Arguments :
5182 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5183 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5184 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5185 select which table entry to update the counters.
5186
5187 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5188 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5189 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5190 that table until the session ends.
5191
5192 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5193 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5194 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5195 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5196 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5197 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5198 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5199 useful information.
5200
5201 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5202 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5203 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5204 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5205 checks that make use of it.
5206
5207http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5208
5209 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005210
5211 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005212 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005213
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005214http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5215
5216 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5217 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5218 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5219 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5220 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5221 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5222
5223 Arguments :
5224 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5225
5226 Example:
5227 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005229http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005231 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5232 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5233 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005234
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005235
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005236http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005237 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5238
5239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5240 no | yes | yes | yes
5241
5242 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5243 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5244 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5245 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5246 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5247 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005249 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5250 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005251
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005252 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005253
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005254 Example:
5255 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005257 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005258
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005259 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5260 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005261
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005262 Example:
5263 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005265 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005266
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005267 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5268 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005269
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005270 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5271 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005272
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005273http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005274
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005275 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5276 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5277 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5278 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5279 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5280 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5281 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5282 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005283
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005284http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005285
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005286 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5287 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5288 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5289 example, or to pass some internal information.
5290 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5291 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5292 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005293
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005294http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005295
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005296 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5297 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005298
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005299http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005300
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005301 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005303http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005304
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005305 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5306 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5307 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5308 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5309 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5310 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5311 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005312
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005313 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5314 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5315 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5316 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5317 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005318
5319 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5320 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5321 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5322 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005324http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005325
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005326 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5327 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5328 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5329 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5330 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5331 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005333http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005334
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005335 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005336
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005337http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005338
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005339 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5340 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5341 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5342 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5343 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5344 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005345
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005346http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5347 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005348
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005349 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005350 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5351 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005352 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5353 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5354 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5355 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5356 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005357 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005358
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005359http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005360
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005361 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5362 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5363 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5364 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5365 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5366 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005367
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005368http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5369 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005370
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005371 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5372 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005373
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005374 Example:
5375 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005376
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005377 # applied to:
5378 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005379
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005380 # outputs:
5381 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005382
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005383 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005384
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005385http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5386 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005387
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005388 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005389 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005391 Example:
5392 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005393
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005394 # applied to:
5395 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005396
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005397 # outputs:
5398 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005399
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005400http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5401http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005402
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005403 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5404 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5405 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005406
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005407http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5408 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005409
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005410 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5411 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5412 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5413 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005414
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005415http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005416
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005417 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5418 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5419 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5420 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5421 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005422
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005423 Arguments:
5424 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005426 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5427 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005429http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005431 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5432 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5433 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005435http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5436
5437 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5438 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5439 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5440 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5441 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5442
5443http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5444
5445 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5446 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5447 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5448 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5449 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5450 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5451 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5452 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5453 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5454
5455http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5456
5457 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5458 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5459 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5460 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5461 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5462 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5463 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5464
5465http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5466
5467 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5468 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5469 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5470 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5471 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5472 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5473 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5474 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5475
5476http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5477 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5478
5479 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5480 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5481 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5482 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005483
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005484 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005485 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5486 http-response set-status 431
5487 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5488 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005489
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005490http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005492 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5493 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5494 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5495 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5496 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5497 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5498 based on some information from the request.
5499
5500 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5501
5502http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5503
5504 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5505 inline.
5506
5507 Arguments:
5508 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5509 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5510 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5511 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5512 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5513 (request and response)
5514 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5515 processing
5516 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5517 processing
5518 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5519 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5520 and '_'.
5521
5522 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5523 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005524
5525 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005526 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005527
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005528http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005530 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5531 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5532 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5533 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5534 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5535 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5536 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5537 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5538 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5539 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5540 action.
5541 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5542 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5543 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5544 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5545 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005546
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005547http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5548
5549 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5550 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5551 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5552 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5553 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5554 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5555 processing.
5556
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005557 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005558 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5559 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5560 rules evaluation.
5561
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005562http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5563http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5564http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005565
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005566 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5567 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5568 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5569 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5570 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5571 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5572
5573http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5574
5575 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5576 about <var-name>.
5577
5578 Example:
5579 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5580
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005581
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005582http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5583 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5584
5585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | no | yes | yes
5587
5588 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005589 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5590 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5591 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005592
5593 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5594
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005595 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5596 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5597 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5598 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5599 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5600 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5601 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5602 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5603 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5604 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005605
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005606 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5607 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5608 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5609 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5610 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5611 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5612 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5613 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005614
5615 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5616 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5617 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5618 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5619 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5620 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5621 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5622 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005623 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005624 downsides of rare connection failures.
5625
5626 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5627 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5628 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5629 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5630 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5631 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005632 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005633 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5634 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5635 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5636 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5637 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5638
5639 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005640 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5641 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5642 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005643
5644 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005645 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005646
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005647 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5648 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005649
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005650 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005651
5652 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5653 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5654 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5655
5656 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5657
5658
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005659http-send-name-header [<header>]
5660 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005661 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5662 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005663 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005664 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5665
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005666 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5667 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5668 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5669 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5670 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5671 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5672 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5673 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5674 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5675 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5676 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5677 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5678 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5679 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5680 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5681 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005682
5683 See also : "server"
5684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005685id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005686 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5688 no | yes | yes | yes
5689 Arguments : none
5690
5691 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5692 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5693 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005694
5695
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005696ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5697 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5698 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005699 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005700
5701 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5702 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5703 and running).
5704
5705 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5706 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5707 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005708 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005709 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5710
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005711 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5712 "unless" condition is met.
5713
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005714 Example:
5715 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5716 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5717 ignore-persist if url_static
5718
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005719 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5720
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005721load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5722 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5723 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5724 yes | no | yes | yes
5725
5726 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5727 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5728 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005729 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005730 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5731 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5732 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5733 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5734
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005735 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005736 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005737 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005738
5739 Arguments:
5740 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5741 named "server-state-file".
5742
5743 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5744 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5745 name is used as a file name.
5746
5747 none don't load any stat for this backend
5748
5749 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005750 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5751 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5752 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005753 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005754 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005755
5756 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5757 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5758
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005759 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005760
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005761 global
5762 stats socket /tmp/socket
5763 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005764
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005765 defaults
5766 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005767
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005768 backend bk
5769 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5770 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005771
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005772
5773 Then one can run :
5774
5775 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5776
5777 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5778
5779 1
5780 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5781 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5782 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5783
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005784 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005785
5786 global
5787 stats socket /tmp/socket
5788 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5789
5790 defaults
5791 load-server-state-from-file local
5792
5793 backend bk
5794 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5795 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5796
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005797
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005798 Then one can run :
5799
5800 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5801
5802 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5803
5804 1
5805 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5806 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5807 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5808
5809 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5810 "show servers state"
5811
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005813log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005814log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5815 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005816no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005817 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5819 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005820
5821 Prefix :
5822 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5823 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5824 prefix does not allow arguments.
5825
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005826 Arguments :
5827 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5828 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5829 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5830 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5831 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5832 parameter.
5833
5834 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5835 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5836
5837 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5838 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5839 standard syslog port).
5840
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005841 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5842 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5843 standard syslog port).
5844
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005845 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5846 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5847 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005848 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005849
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005850 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5851 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5852 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5853 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5854 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5855 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5856 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5857 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5858 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5859 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5860 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5861 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5862 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5863 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5864 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5865 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005866 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5867 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005868
5869 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5870 and "fd@2", see above.
5871
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005872 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5873 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5874 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5875 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5876 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5877 having the logs instantly available.
5878
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005879 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5880 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005881
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005882 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5883 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5884 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5885 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5886 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5887 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5888 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5889 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5890 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5891 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005892 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005893
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005894 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5895 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5896 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5897 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5898 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5899
5900 <sample_size>
5901 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5902 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5903 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5904 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5905 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5906
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005907 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5908 one of the following :
5909
5910 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5911 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5912
5913 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5914 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5915
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005916 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5917 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5918 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5919 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5920 systemd logger consumes.
5921
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005922 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5923 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5924 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5925 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5926
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005927 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5928
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005929 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5930 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5931 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5932
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005933 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5934 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5935 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5936 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005937
5938 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5939 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5940 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005941 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5942 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5943 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5944 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5945 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005946
5947 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5948
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005949 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5950 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5951 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005952
5953 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5954 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5955 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5956 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5957
5958 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5959 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005960
5961 Example :
5962 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005963 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5964 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5965 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005966 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5967 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005968 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005969
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005970
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005971log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005972 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5974 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005975
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005976 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5977 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5978 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5979 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5980 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005981
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005982 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5983 "option httplog" directives.
5984
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005985log-format-sd <string>
5986 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5988 yes | yes | yes | no
5989
5990 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5991 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5992 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5993 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5994 which covers the log format string in depth.
5995
5996 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5997 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5998
5999 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6000 log format to "rfc5424".
6001
6002 Example :
6003 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6004
6005
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006006log-tag <string>
6007 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6009 yes | yes | yes | yes
6010
6011 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6012 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6013 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6014 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6015 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6016 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6017 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6018 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6019 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006020
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006021max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6022 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6023 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6024 yes | no | yes | yes
6025
6026 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6027 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6028 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6029 servers.
6030
6031 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6032 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6033 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6034 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6035 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006036 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006037 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6038 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6039 picking a different server.
6040
6041 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6042 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6043 even if they have to be queued.
6044
6045 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6046 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6047
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006048max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6049 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6050 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6051 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006052
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006053maxconn <conns>
6054 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6056 yes | yes | yes | no
6057 Arguments :
6058 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6059 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6060 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6061 closes.
6062
6063 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6064 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6065 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6066 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006067 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6068 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6069 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6070 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006071
6072 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6073 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6074 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6075
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006076 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6077 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006078
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006079 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6080
6081
6082mode { tcp|http|health }
6083 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6085 yes | yes | yes | yes
6086 Arguments :
6087 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6088 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6089 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6090 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6091
6092 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6093 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6094 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6095 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6096 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6097
6098 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006099 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6100 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6101 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6102 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6103 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6104 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6105 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006106
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006107 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6108 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6109 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006110
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006111 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006112 defaults http_instances
6113 mode http
6114
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006115 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006116
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006118monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006119 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6121 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006122 Arguments :
6123 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6124 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006125 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006126 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6127 backend and its backup.
6128
6129 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6130 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6131 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6132 servers in a list of backends.
6133
6134 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6135 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6136 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6137 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6138 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6139 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6140 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006141 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6142 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006143
6144 Example:
6145 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006146 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006147 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6148 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6149 monitor-uri /site_alive
6150 monitor fail if site_dead
6151
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006152 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006153
6154
6155monitor-net <source>
6156 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6158 yes | yes | yes | no
6159 Arguments :
6160 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6161 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6162 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6163 followed by a mask.
6164
6165 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6166 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006167 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006168 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6169
6170 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6171 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6172 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6173 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006174 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6175 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6176 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006177
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006178 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6179 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6180 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6181 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6182 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6183 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006184
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006185 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6186 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006187
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006188 Example :
6189 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6190 frontend www
6191 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6192
6193 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6194
6195
6196monitor-uri <uri>
6197 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6199 yes | yes | yes | no
6200 Arguments :
6201 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6202 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6203
6204 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6205 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6206 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6207 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6208 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6209 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6210 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6211 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6212
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006213 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006214 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6215 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6216 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6217 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6218 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6219 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006220
6221 Example :
6222 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6223 frontend www
6224 mode http
6225 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6226
6227 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006229
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006230option abortonclose
6231no option abortonclose
6232 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6234 yes | no | yes | yes
6235 Arguments : none
6236
6237 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6238 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6239 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6240 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006241 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006242 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6243 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6244 encountered while delivering the response.
6245
6246 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6247 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6248 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6249 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6250 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6251 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006252 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006253 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006254 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006255 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6256 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6257 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6258
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006259 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6260 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006261 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6262 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6263 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6264 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6265 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6266 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006267 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006268
6269 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6270 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6271
6272 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6273
6274
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006275option accept-invalid-http-request
6276no option accept-invalid-http-request
6277 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6279 yes | yes | yes | no
6280 Arguments : none
6281
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006282 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006283 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006284 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006285 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6286 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6287 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6288 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6289 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006290 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6291 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6292 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6293 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006294 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006295 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006296 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6297 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6298 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006299
6300 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6301 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6302 been confirmed.
6303
6304 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6305 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006306 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6307 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006308 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6309
6310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6312
6313 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6314 stats socket.
6315
6316
6317option accept-invalid-http-response
6318no option accept-invalid-http-response
6319 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 yes | no | yes | yes
6322 Arguments : none
6323
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006324 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006325 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006326 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006327 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6328 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6329 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6330 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6331 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006332 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6333 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6334 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006335
6336 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6337 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6338 been confirmed.
6339
6340 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6341 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6342 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6343 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6344
6345 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6346 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6347
6348 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6349 stats socket.
6350
6351
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006352option allbackups
6353no option allbackups
6354 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6356 yes | no | yes | yes
6357 Arguments : none
6358
6359 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6360 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6361 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6362 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6363 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6364 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6365 order between the backup servers anymore.
6366
6367 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6368 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6369
6370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6372
6373
6374option checkcache
6375no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006376 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6378 yes | no | yes | yes
6379 Arguments : none
6380
6381 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6382 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006383 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006384 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6385 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006386 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006387
6388 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006389 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006390 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006391 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6392 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006393 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006394 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006395 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6396 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006397 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006398 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6399 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006400 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006401 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6402 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6403 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6404 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6405 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6406 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6407 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6408 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6409 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6410
6411 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006412 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6413 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6414 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6415 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006416
6417 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6418 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006419 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006420 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006421
6422 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6423 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6424
6425
6426option clitcpka
6427no option clitcpka
6428 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 yes | yes | yes | no
6431 Arguments : none
6432
6433 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6434 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006435 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006436 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6437
6438 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6439 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6440 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6441 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6442
6443 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6444 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6445 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6446 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6447 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6448
6449 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6450
6451 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6452 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6453 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6454
6455 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6456 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6457
6458 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6459
6460
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006461option contstats
6462 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6464 yes | yes | yes | no
6465 Arguments : none
6466
6467 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6468 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6469 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6470 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006471 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6472 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6473 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6474 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6475 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006476
6477
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006478option dontlog-normal
6479no option dontlog-normal
6480 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6482 yes | yes | yes | no
6483 Arguments : none
6484
6485 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6486 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6487 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6488 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6489 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6490 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6491 logged.
6492
6493 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6494 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6495 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006497 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006498 logging.
6499
6500
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006501option dontlognull
6502no option dontlognull
6503 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6505 yes | yes | yes | no
6506 Arguments : none
6507
6508 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6509 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6510 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6511 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6512 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6513 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006514 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6515 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6516 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006517
6518 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006519 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006520 would not be logged.
6521
6522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6524
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006525 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6526 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006527
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006528
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006529option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006530 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6532 yes | yes | yes | yes
6533 Arguments :
6534 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6535 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006536 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006537 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006538
6539 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6540 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6541 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6542 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6543 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6544 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6545 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006546 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6547 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6548 possible that the client has already brought one.
6549
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006550 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006551 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006552 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006553 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006554 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006555 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006556
6557 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6558 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6559 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6560 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6561 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6562 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6563 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6564
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006565 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6566 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6567 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6568 are under the control of the end-user.
6569
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006570 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006571 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6572 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006573 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6574 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6575 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006576
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006577 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006578 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6579 frontend www
6580 mode http
6581 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6582
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006583 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6584 backend www
6585 mode http
6586 option forwardfor header X-Client
6587
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006588 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006589 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006590
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006591
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006592option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6593no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6594 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6596 yes | yes | yes | no
6597 Arguments : none
6598
6599 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6600 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6601 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6602 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6603 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6604 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6605 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6606
6607 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6608 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6609 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6610 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6611 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6612 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6613 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6614 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6615 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6616 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6617
6618 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6619
6620 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6621 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6622
6623 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6624 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6625
6626
6627option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6628no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6629 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 yes | no | yes | yes
6632 Arguments : none
6633
6634 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6635 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6636 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6637 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6638 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6639 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6640 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6641
6642 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6643 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6644 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6645 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6646 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6647 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6648 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6649 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6650 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6651 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6652
6653 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6654
6655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6657
6658 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6659 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6660
6661
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006662option http-buffer-request
6663no option http-buffer-request
6664 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6666 yes | yes | yes | yes
6667 Arguments : none
6668
6669 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6670 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6671 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6672 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6673 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6674 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006675 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6676 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6677 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6678 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006679
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006680 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006681
6682
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006683option http-ignore-probes
6684no option http-ignore-probes
6685 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6687 yes | yes | yes | no
6688 Arguments : none
6689
6690 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6691 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6692 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6693 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6694 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6695 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6696 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6697 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6698 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006699 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6700 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006701 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6702
6703 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6704 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6705 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6706 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6707 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6708 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6709 are often the only way to detect them.
6710
6711 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6712 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6713
6714 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6715
6716
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006717option http-keep-alive
6718no option http-keep-alive
6719 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6721 yes | yes | yes | yes
6722 Arguments : none
6723
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006724 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6725 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006726 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6727 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006728 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6729 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6730 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006731
6732 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6733 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006734 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6735 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6736 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6737 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6738 situations where this option may be useful :
6739
6740 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006741 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006742
6743 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6744 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6745
6746 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6747 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6748 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6749 request.
6750
6751 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6752 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006753 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6754 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6755 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006756
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006757 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6758 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6759 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6760 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6761 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6762 not set.
6763
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006764 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6765 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6766 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006767
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006768 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006769 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006770 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006771
6772
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006773option http-no-delay
6774no option http-no-delay
6775 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6777 yes | yes | yes | yes
6778 Arguments : none
6779
6780 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6781 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6782 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6783 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6784 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6785 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6786 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6787 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6788 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6789 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6790 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6791 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6792 affected.
6793
6794 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6795 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6796 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6797 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6798 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6799 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6800 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6801 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6802 latency environments.
6803
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006804 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6805
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006806
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006807option http-pretend-keepalive
6808no option http-pretend-keepalive
6809 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006811 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006812 Arguments : none
6813
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006814 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006815 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6816 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6817 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6818 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6819 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6820 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6821 consider the response complete.
6822
6823 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6824 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6825 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6826 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006827 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006828 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6829
6830 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6831 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6832 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6833 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6834 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6835 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6836 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6837
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006838 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6839 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6840 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6841 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6842 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6843 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006844
6845 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6846 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6847
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006848 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006849 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006850
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006851
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006852option http-server-close
6853no option http-server-close
6854 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6856 yes | yes | yes | yes
6857 Arguments : none
6858
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006859 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6860 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6861 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6862 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006863 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6864 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6865 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6866 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6867 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6868 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6869 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6870 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6871 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6872 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6873 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006874
6875 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6876 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6877 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6878 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006879 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6880 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006881
6882 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6883 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006884 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6885 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6886 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006887
6888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6890
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006891 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6892 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006893
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006894option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006895no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006896 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6898 yes | yes | yes | no
6899 Arguments : none
6900
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006901 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006902 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6903 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6904 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6905 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6906 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6907 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6908
6909 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6910 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006911 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6912 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6913 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006914
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006915 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6916 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6917 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6918 front of an existing proxy.
6919
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006920 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6921
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006922 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006923
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006924option httpchk
6925option httpchk <uri>
6926option httpchk <method> <uri>
6927option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6928 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6930 yes | no | yes | yes
6931 Arguments :
6932 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6933 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6934 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6935 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6936 ones.
6937
6938 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6939 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6940 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6941
6942 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6943 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6944 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6945 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6946 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6947
6948 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6949 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6950 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6951 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6952 the lack of any response.
6953
6954 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6955
6956 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6957 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6958 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6959
6960 Examples :
6961 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6962 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6963 backend https_relay
6964 mode tcp
6965 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6966 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6967
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006968 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6969 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6970 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006971
6972
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006973option httpclose
6974no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006975 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6977 yes | yes | yes | yes
6978 Arguments : none
6979
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006980 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6981 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6982 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6983 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006984 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006985
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006986 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6987 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006988 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006989 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6990 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006991
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006992 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6993 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6994 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006995
6996 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6997 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006998 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6999 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7000 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007001
7002 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7003 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7004
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007005 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007006
7007
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007008option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007009 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007011 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007012 Arguments :
7013 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7014 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7015 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007016 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007017 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007018
7019 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7020 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7021 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7022 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7023 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7024 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7025 ports.
7026
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007027 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7028 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007029
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007030 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007032 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007033
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007034
7035option http_proxy
7036no option http_proxy
7037 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7039 yes | yes | yes | yes
7040 Arguments : none
7041
7042 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7043 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7044 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7045 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7046 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7047
7048 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7049 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007050 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7051 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007052
7053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7055
7056 Example :
7057 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7058 backend direct_forward
7059 option httpclose
7060 option http_proxy
7061
7062 See also : "option httpclose"
7063
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007064
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007065option independent-streams
7066no option independent-streams
7067 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7069 yes | yes | yes | yes
7070 Arguments : none
7071
7072 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7073 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7074 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7075 receive data or not.
7076
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007077 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007078 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7079 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7080 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7081 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7082 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7083 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7084 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7085 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7086 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7087 socket buffers.
7088
7089 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7090 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7091 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7092 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7093 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7094
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007095 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007096
7097
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007098option ldap-check
7099 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7101 yes | no | yes | yes
7102 Arguments : none
7103
7104 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7105 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7106 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7107 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7108
7109 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7110 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7111
7112 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7113 configure it.
7114
7115 Example :
7116 option ldap-check
7117
7118 See also : "option httpchk"
7119
7120
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007121option external-check
7122 Use external processes for server health checks
7123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7124 yes | no | yes | yes
7125
7126 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7127 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7128 command".
7129
7130 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7131
7132 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7133
7134
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007135option log-health-checks
7136no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007137 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7139 yes | no | yes | yes
7140 Arguments : none
7141
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007142 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7143 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7144 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007145
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007146 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7147 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7148 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7149 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7150 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7151
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007152 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007153 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007154
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007155 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7156 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7157 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007158
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007159
7160option log-separate-errors
7161no option log-separate-errors
7162 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7164 yes | yes | yes | no
7165 Arguments : none
7166
7167 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7168 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7169 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7170 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7171 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7172 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7173 provides very important information.
7174
7175 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7176 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7177 error logs.
7178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007179 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007180 logging.
7181
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007182
7183option logasap
7184no option logasap
7185 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
7186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7187 yes | yes | yes | no
7188 Arguments : none
7189
7190 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
7191 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
7192 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
7193 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
7194 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
7195 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
7196 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007197 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007198 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
7199 bytes are expected to be transferred.
7200
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007201 Examples :
7202 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7203 mode http
7204 option httplog
7205 option logasap
7206 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7207
7208 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7209 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7210 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7211 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007214 logging.
7215
7216
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007217option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007218 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7220 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007221 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007222 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7223 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007224 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007225
7226 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7227 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007228 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007229 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7230 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7231 in the MySQL table, like this :
7232
7233 USE mysql;
7234 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7235 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7236
7237 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007238 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007239 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7240 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7241 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7242 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7243 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7244 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7245 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7246
7247 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7248 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007249
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007250 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007251
7252 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7253 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7254 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7255 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007256 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7257 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007258
7259 See also: "option httpchk"
7260
7261
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007262option nolinger
7263no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007264 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7266 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007267 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007268
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007269 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007270 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7271 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7272 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7273 connections.
7274
7275 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7276 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7277 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7278 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7279 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7280 this too.
7281
7282 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7283 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7284 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7285
7286 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7287 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7288 for servers.
7289
7290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7292
7293
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007294option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7295 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7297 yes | yes | yes | yes
7298 Arguments :
7299 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7300 matching <network>
7301 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7302 header name.
7303
7304 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7305 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7306 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7307 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7308 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7309 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7310 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7311 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7312 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7313 possible that the client has already brought one.
7314
7315 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7316 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7317 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7318 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7319 header and requires different one.
7320
7321 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7322 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7323 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7324 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7325 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7326 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7327 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7328
7329 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7330 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7331 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7332 both are defined.
7333
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007334 Examples :
7335 # Original Destination address
7336 frontend www
7337 mode http
7338 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7339
7340 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7341 backend www
7342 mode http
7343 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7344
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007345 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007346
7347
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007348option persist
7349no option persist
7350 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7351 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7352 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007353 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007354
7355 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7356 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7357 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7358 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7359 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7360 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7361 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7362 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7363 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7364 redirected to another valid server.
7365
7366 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7367 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7368
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007369 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007370
7371
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007372option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7373 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7375 yes | no | yes | yes
7376 Arguments :
7377 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7378 PostgreSQL server.
7379
7380 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7381 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7382 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7383 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7384
7385 See also: "option httpchk"
7386
7387
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007388option prefer-last-server
7389no option prefer-last-server
7390 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7391 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7392 yes | no | yes | yes
7393 Arguments : none
7394
7395 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7396 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7397 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7398 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7399 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7400 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7401 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7402 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7403 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007404 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7405 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007406 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7407 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7408 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007409 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7410 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7411 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007412
7413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7415
7416 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7417
7418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007419option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007420option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007421no option redispatch
7422 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7423 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7424 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007425 Arguments :
7426 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7427 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7428 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007429 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007430 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007431 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007432 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7433 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7434 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007436
7437 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7438 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7439 be able to access the service anymore.
7440
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007441 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7442 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007443
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007444 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007445 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7446 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7450
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007451 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007452
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007453
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007454option redis-check
7455 Use redis health checks for server testing
7456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7457 yes | no | yes | yes
7458 Arguments : none
7459
7460 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7461 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7462 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7463 find the "+PONG" response message.
7464
7465 Example :
7466 option redis-check
7467
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007468 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007469
7470
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007471option smtpchk
7472option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7473 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7475 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007476 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007477 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007478 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007479 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7480
7481 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7482 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7483 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7484
7485 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7486 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7487 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7488 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7489 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7490 dead server.
7491
7492 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7493 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007494 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007495 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7496
7497 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7498 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7499 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7500 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007501 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007502
7503 Example :
7504 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7505
7506 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007509option socket-stats
7510no option socket-stats
7511
7512 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7514 yes | yes | yes | no
7515
7516 Arguments : none
7517
7518
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007519option splice-auto
7520no option splice-auto
7521 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7523 yes | yes | yes | yes
7524 Arguments : none
7525
7526 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7527 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007528 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007529 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007530 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007531 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7532 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7533 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7534 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7535
7536 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7537 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7538 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7539 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7540 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7541 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7542 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7543 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7544 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7545 keyword.
7546
7547 Example :
7548 option splice-auto
7549
7550 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7551 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7552
7553 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7554 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7555
7556
7557option splice-request
7558no option splice-request
7559 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7561 yes | yes | yes | yes
7562 Arguments : none
7563
7564 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007565 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007566 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7567 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7568 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7569 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7570
7571 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7572
7573 Example :
7574 option splice-request
7575
7576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7578
7579 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7580 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7581
7582
7583option splice-response
7584no option splice-response
7585 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7587 yes | yes | yes | yes
7588 Arguments : none
7589
7590 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007591 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007592 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7593 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7594 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7595 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7596
7597 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7598
7599 Example :
7600 option splice-response
7601
7602 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7603 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7604
7605 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7606 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7607
7608
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007609option spop-check
7610 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7612 no | no | no | yes
7613 Arguments : none
7614
7615 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7616 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7617 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7618 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7619
7620 Example :
7621 option spop-check
7622
7623 See also : "option httpchk"
7624
7625
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007626option srvtcpka
7627no option srvtcpka
7628 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7630 yes | no | yes | yes
7631 Arguments : none
7632
7633 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7634 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007635 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007636 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7637
7638 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7639 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7640 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7641 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7642
7643 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7644 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7645 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7646 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7647 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7648
7649 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7650
7651 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7652 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7653 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7654
7655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7657
7658 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7659
7660
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007661option ssl-hello-chk
7662 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7664 yes | no | yes | yes
7665 Arguments : none
7666
7667 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7668 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7669 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7670 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7671 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7672 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7673 hello message.
7674
7675 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7676 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7677 messages, which is appreciable.
7678
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007679 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7680 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7681 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007682
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007683 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7684
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007685
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007686option tcp-check
7687 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7688 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7689 yes | no | yes | yes
7690
7691 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7692 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7693
7694 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7695 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7696 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7697
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007698 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007699 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7700 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7701 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7702 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7703 only.
7704
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007705 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007706 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7707 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7708 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7709 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7710
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007711 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007712 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7713 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007714 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007715 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7716 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7717 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7718 the respective protocols.
7719 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007720 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007721
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007722 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7723 script.
7724
7725 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7726 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7727 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7728 The "comment" is of course optional.
7729
7730
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007731 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007732 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007733 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007734 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007735
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007736 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007737 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007738 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007739
7740 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7741 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007742 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007743 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007744 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007745 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007746 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007747 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007748 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7749 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007750 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007751 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7752 tcp-check expect string +OK
7753
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007754 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007755 (send many headers before analyzing)
7756 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007757 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007758 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7759 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7760 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7761 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007762 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007763
7764
7765 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7766
7767
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007768option tcp-smart-accept
7769no option tcp-smart-accept
7770 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7772 yes | yes | yes | no
7773 Arguments : none
7774
7775 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7776 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7777 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7778 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7779 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7780 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7781
7782 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7783 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7784 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7785 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7786
7787 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7788 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7789 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007790 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007791
7792 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7793 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7794 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7795
7796 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7797 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7798 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7799
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007800 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7801
7802
7803option tcp-smart-connect
7804no option tcp-smart-connect
7805 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7807 yes | no | yes | yes
7808 Arguments : none
7809
7810 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7811 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7812 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7813 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7814 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7815
7816 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7817 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7818 complex.
7819
7820 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7821 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7822 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7823
7824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7826
7827 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7828
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007829
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007830option tcpka
7831 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7833 yes | yes | yes | yes
7834 Arguments : none
7835
7836 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7837 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007838 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007839 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7840
7841 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7842 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7843 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7844 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7845
7846 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7847 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7848 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7849 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7850 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7851
7852 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7853
7854 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7855 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7856 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7857 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7858 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7859 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7860 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7861 backends.
7862
7863 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7864
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007865
7866option tcplog
7867 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007869 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007870 Arguments : none
7871
7872 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7873 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7874 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7875 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7876 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7877 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7878 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7879 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7880
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007881 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007883 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007884
7885
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007886option transparent
7887no option transparent
7888 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007890 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007891 Arguments : none
7892
7893 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7894 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7895 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7896 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7897 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7898 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7899 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7900 appropriate server.
7901
7902 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7903 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7904
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007905 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007906 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007907
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007908
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007909external-check command <command>
7910 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7912 yes | no | yes | yes
7913
7914 Arguments :
7915 <command> is the external command to run
7916
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007917 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7918
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007919 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007920
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007921 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7922 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7923 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7924 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7925 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7926 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007927
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007928 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7929
7930 Environment variables :
7931 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7932 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7933
7934 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7935
7936 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7937
7938 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7939 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7940 for a UNIX socket).
7941
7942 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7943
7944 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7945
7946 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7947
7948 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7949
7950 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7951
7952 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7953 socket).
7954
7955 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7956 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7957
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007958 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7959
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007960 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7961 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7962 failed.
7963
7964 Example :
7965 external-check command /bin/true
7966
7967 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7968
7969
7970external-check path <path>
7971 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7973 yes | no | yes | yes
7974
7975 Arguments :
7976 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7977
7978 The default path is "".
7979
7980 Example :
7981 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7982
7983 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7984 "external-check command"
7985
7986
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007987persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007988persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007989 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7991 yes | no | yes | yes
7992 Arguments :
7993 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007994 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7995 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007996
7997 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7998 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007999 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008000 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8001 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8002 forwarded to this server.
8003
8004 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8005 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8006 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008007 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008008 a single "listen" section.
8009
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008010 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8011 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8012 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8013
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008014 Example :
8015 listen tse-farm
8016 bind :3389
8017 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8018 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8019 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8020 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8021 persist rdp-cookie
8022 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008023 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008024 balance rdp-cookie
8025 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8026 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8027
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008028 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8029 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008030
8031
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008032rate-limit sessions <rate>
8033 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8035 yes | yes | yes | no
8036 Arguments :
8037 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8038 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8039
8040 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8041 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8042 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8043 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8044 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8045 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8046
8047 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8048 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8049 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8050 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8051
8052 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8053 listen smtp
8054 mode tcp
8055 bind :25
8056 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008057 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008058
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008059 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8060 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8061 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008062
8063 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8064
8065
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008066redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8067redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8068redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008069 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8071 no | yes | yes | yes
8072
8073 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008074 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008075
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008076 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008077 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008078 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8079 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8080 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008081
8082 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8083 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8084 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8085 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8086 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008087 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8088 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8089 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8090 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008091
8092 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8093 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8094 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8095 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8096 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8097 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008098 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008099 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008100 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8101 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8102 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008103
8104 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008105 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8106 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8107 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008108 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008109 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8110 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8111 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8112 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008113
8114 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008115 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008116
8117 - "drop-query"
8118 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8119 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8120 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8121 with a location-type redirect.
8122
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008123 - "append-slash"
8124 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8125 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8126 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8127 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8128
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008129 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8130 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8131 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8132 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8133 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8134 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8135 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8136
8137 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8138 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8139 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8140 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8141 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8142 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8143 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008144
8145 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8146 acl clear dst_port 80
8147 acl secure dst_port 8080
8148 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008149 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008150 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008151 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8152
8153 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008154 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8155 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8156 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008157 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008158
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008159 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8160 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8161 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8162
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008163 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008164 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008165
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008166 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008167 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8168 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8169 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008171 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008172
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008173
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008174retries <value>
8175 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8176 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8177 yes | no | yes | yes
8178 Arguments :
8179 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8180 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8181 default value is 3.
8182
8183 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8184 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8185 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8186
8187 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008188 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8189 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008190
8191 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8192 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8193
8194 See also : "option redispatch"
8195
8196
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008197retry-on [list of keywords]
8198 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8199 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8200 yes | no | yes | yes
8201 Arguments :
8202 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8203 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8204 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8205 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8206
8207 none never retry
8208
8209 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8210 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8211
8212 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8213 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8214 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8215 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8216 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8217 processing the request.
8218
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008219 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8220 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8221 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8222 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8223 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8224 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8225 overflow attack for example).
8226
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008227 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8228 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8229 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8230 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8231 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8232 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8233 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8234 amplify denial of service attacks.
8235
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008236 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8237 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8238 considered to be safe to retry.
8239
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008240 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8241 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8242 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8243 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8244
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008245 all-retryable-errors
8246 retry request for any error that are considered
8247 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8248 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8249 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8250
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008251 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8252 not cumulative.
8253
8254 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8255 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8256 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8257 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8258
8259 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8260 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8261 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8262 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8263 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8264 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8265 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8266 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8267 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8268 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8269 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8270 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8271
8272 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8273 should not use this directive.
8274
8275 The default is "conn-failure".
8276
8277 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8278
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008279server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008280 Declare a server in a backend
8281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8282 no | no | yes | yes
8283 Arguments :
8284 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008285 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008286 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008287
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008288 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8289 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8290 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8291 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008292 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8293 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8294 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8295 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8296 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008297 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8298 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8299 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8300 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8301 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8302 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8303 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008304 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008305 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8306 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8307 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8308 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8309 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8310 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008311 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8312 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008313 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8314 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008315
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008316 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008317 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8318 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8319 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8320 adding this value to the client's port.
8321
8322 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8323 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008324 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008325
8326 Examples :
8327 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8328 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008329 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008330 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8331 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8332 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008333
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008334 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8335 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8336 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8337 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8338 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8339
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008340 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8341 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008342
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008343server-state-file-name [<file>]
8344 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8345 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8346 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8347 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8348 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8349 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8350
8351 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8352 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8353
8354 global
8355 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8356
8357 backend bk
8358 load-server-state-from-file
8359
8360 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8361 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008362
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008363server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8364 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8365 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8367 no | no | yes | yes
8368
8369 Arguments:
8370 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8371
8372 <num | range>
8373 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8374 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8375 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8376 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8377
8378 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8379
8380 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8381
8382 <params*>
8383 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8384 keyword.
8385
8386 Examples:
8387 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8388 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8389 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8390
8391 # or
8392 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8393
8394 # would be equivalent to:
8395 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8396 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8397 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8398
8399
8400
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008401source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008402source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008403source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008404 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8406 yes | no | yes | yes
8407 Arguments :
8408 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8409 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008410
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008411 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008412 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8413 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8414 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8415 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8416 supported prefixes are :
8417 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8418 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8419 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008420 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008421 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8422 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008423
8424 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8425 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008426 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8427 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8428 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008429
8430 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8431 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8432 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8433 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8434 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8435 <addr>.
8436
8437 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8438 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8439 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8440 port.
8441
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008442 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8443 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8444 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8445 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008446 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008447 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8448 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8449 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8450 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8451 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8452 HTTP header.
8453
8454 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8455 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008456 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008457 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8458 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8459 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8460 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8461 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8462 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8463 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8464
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008465 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8466 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8467 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8468 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8469 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8470 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8471
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008472 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8473 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8474 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8475 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8476
8477 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8478 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8479 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8480 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8481 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8482 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8483
8484 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8485 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8486 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8487 there are two methods :
8488
8489 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8490 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8491 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8492 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8493 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8494 of the client ranges may be used.
8495
8496 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8497 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8498 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8499 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8500 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8501 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8502 same session.
8503
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008504 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8505 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8506 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008507 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008508
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008509 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8510
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008511 Examples :
8512 backend private
8513 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8514 source 192.168.1.200
8515
8516 backend transparent_ssl1
8517 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8518 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8519
8520 backend transparent_ssl2
8521 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8522 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8523 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8524
8525 backend transparent_ssl3
8526 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8527 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8528 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8529
8530 backend transparent_smtp
8531 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8532 # with Tproxy version 4.
8533 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8534
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008535 backend transparent_http
8536 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8537 # proxy.
8538 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008540 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008541 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8542
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008543
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008544stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8545 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008547 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008548
8549 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8550 matched.
8551
8552 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8553 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8554
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008555 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8556 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008557 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008558
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008559 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8560 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8561 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8562 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008563
8564 Example :
8565 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8566 backend stats_localhost
8567 stats enable
8568 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8569
8570 Example :
8571 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8572 backend stats_auth
8573 stats enable
8574 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8575 stats admin if TRUE
8576
8577 Example :
8578 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8579 userlist stats-auth
8580 group admin users admin
8581 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8582 group readonly users haproxy
8583 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8584
8585 backend stats_auth
8586 stats enable
8587 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8588 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8589 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8590 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8591
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008592 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8593 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8594 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008595
8596
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008597stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8598 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008600 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008601 Arguments :
8602 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8603
8604 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8605
8606 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8607 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8608 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8609 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8610 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8611 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8612
8613 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8614 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8615 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008616 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008617
8618 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8619 report using "stats scope".
8620
8621 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8622 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8623 unobvious parameters.
8624
8625 Example :
8626 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8627 backend public_www
8628 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8629 stats enable
8630 stats hide-version
8631 stats scope .
8632 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008633 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008634 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8635 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8636
8637 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8638 backend private_monitoring
8639 stats enable
8640 stats uri /admin?stats
8641 stats refresh 5s
8642
8643 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8644
8645
8646stats enable
8647 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008649 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008650 Arguments : none
8651
8652 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8653 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8654 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8655 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8656 - stats auth : no authentication
8657 - stats scope : no restriction
8658
8659 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8660 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8661 unobvious parameters.
8662
8663 Example :
8664 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8665 backend public_www
8666 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8667 stats enable
8668 stats hide-version
8669 stats scope .
8670 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008671 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008672 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8673 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8674
8675 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8676 backend private_monitoring
8677 stats enable
8678 stats uri /admin?stats
8679 stats refresh 5s
8680
8681 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8682
8683
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008684stats hide-version
8685 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008687 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008688 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008689
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008690 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8691 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8692 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8693 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8694 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8695 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008697 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8698 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8699 unobvious parameters.
8700
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008701 Example :
8702 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8703 backend public_www
8704 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008705 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008706 stats hide-version
8707 stats scope .
8708 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008709 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008710 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8711 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008712
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008713 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8714 backend private_monitoring
8715 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008716 stats uri /admin?stats
8717 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008718
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008719 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008720
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008721
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008722stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8723 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8724 Access control for statistics
8725
8726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8727 no | no | yes | yes
8728
8729 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8730 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8731 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8732 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8733 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8734 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8735
8736 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8737 instance.
8738
8739 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8740 about ACL usage.
8741
8742
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008743stats realm <realm>
8744 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008746 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008747 Arguments :
8748 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8749 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8750 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8751
8752 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8753 using a backslash ('\').
8754
8755 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8756 only related to authentication.
8757
8758 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8759 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8760 unobvious parameters.
8761
8762 Example :
8763 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8764 backend public_www
8765 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8766 stats enable
8767 stats hide-version
8768 stats scope .
8769 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008770 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008771 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8772 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8773
8774 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8775 backend private_monitoring
8776 stats enable
8777 stats uri /admin?stats
8778 stats refresh 5s
8779
8780 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8781
8782
8783stats refresh <delay>
8784 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008786 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008787 Arguments :
8788 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8789 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8790 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8791 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8792 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8793 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8794
8795 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8796 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8797 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8798 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8799
8800 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8801 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8802 unobvious parameters.
8803
8804 Example :
8805 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8806 backend public_www
8807 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8808 stats enable
8809 stats hide-version
8810 stats scope .
8811 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008812 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008813 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8814 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8815
8816 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8817 backend private_monitoring
8818 stats enable
8819 stats uri /admin?stats
8820 stats refresh 5s
8821
8822 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8823
8824
8825stats scope { <name> | "." }
8826 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008828 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008829 Arguments :
8830 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8831 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8832 section in which the statement appears.
8833
8834 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8835 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8836 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8837 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8838 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8839 exists.
8840
8841 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8842 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8843 unobvious parameters.
8844
8845 Example :
8846 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8847 backend public_www
8848 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8849 stats enable
8850 stats hide-version
8851 stats scope .
8852 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008853 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008854 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8855 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8856
8857 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8858 backend private_monitoring
8859 stats enable
8860 stats uri /admin?stats
8861 stats refresh 5s
8862
8863 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8864
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008865
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008866stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008867 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008869 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008870
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008871 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008872 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8873
8874 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8875 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8876
8877 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8878 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008879 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008880
8881 Example :
8882 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8883 backend private_monitoring
8884 stats enable
8885 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8886 stats uri /admin?stats
8887 stats refresh 5s
8888
8889 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8890 global section.
8891
8892
8893stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008894 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8896 yes | yes | yes | yes
8897 Arguments : none
8898
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008899 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008900 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8901 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8902 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8903 - IP (socket, server)
8904 - cookie (backend, server)
8905
8906 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8907 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008908 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008909
8910 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8911
8912
8913stats show-node [ <name> ]
8914 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008916 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008917 Arguments:
8918 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8919 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8920
8921 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8922 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008923 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008924
8925 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8926 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8927 unobvious parameters.
8928
8929 Example:
8930 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8931 backend private_monitoring
8932 stats enable
8933 stats show-node Europe-1
8934 stats uri /admin?stats
8935 stats refresh 5s
8936
8937 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8938 section.
8939
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008940
8941stats uri <prefix>
8942 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008944 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008945 Arguments :
8946 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8947 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8948 query string.
8949
8950 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8951 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8952 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8953 possible to reach it in the application.
8954
8955 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008956 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008957 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8958 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8959 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8960 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8961
8962 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8963 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8964 an address or a port to statistics only.
8965
8966 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8967 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8968 unobvious parameters.
8969
8970 Example :
8971 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8972 backend public_www
8973 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8974 stats enable
8975 stats hide-version
8976 stats scope .
8977 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008978 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008979 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8980 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8981
8982 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8983 backend private_monitoring
8984 stats enable
8985 stats uri /admin?stats
8986 stats refresh 5s
8987
8988 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8989
8990
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008991stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8992 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008994 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008995
8996 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008997 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008998 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008999 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009000 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9001
9002 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9003 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9004 the "stick-table" statement.
9005
9006 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9007 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9008 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9009 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9010 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9011
9012 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9013 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9014 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9015 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9016 transformation rules.
9017
9018 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9019 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9020 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9021 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9022 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9023 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9024 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9025
9026 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9027 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9028 ACL based conditions.
9029
9030 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9031 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9032 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9033 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9034
9035 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9036 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9037 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9038 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9039
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009040 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9041 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009042 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009043
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009044 Example :
9045 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9046 # last 30 minutes
9047 backend pop
9048 mode tcp
9049 balance roundrobin
9050 stick store-request src
9051 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9052 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9053 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9054
9055 backend smtp
9056 mode tcp
9057 balance roundrobin
9058 stick match src table pop
9059 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9060 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9061
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009062 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009063 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009064
9065
9066stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9067 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9069 no | no | yes | yes
9070
9071 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9072 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9073 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9074 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9075
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009076 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9077 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009078 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009079
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009080 Examples :
9081 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009082 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009083
9084 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9085 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9086 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9087
9088
9089 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9090 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9091 backend http
9092 mode http
9093 balance roundrobin
9094 stick on src table https
9095 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9096 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9097 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9098
9099 backend https
9100 mode tcp
9101 balance roundrobin
9102 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9103 stick on src
9104 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9105 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9106
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009107 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009108
9109
9110stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9111 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9113 no | no | yes | yes
9114
9115 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009116 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009117 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009118 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009119 server is selected.
9120
9121 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9122 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9123 the "stick-table" statement.
9124
9125 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9126 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9127 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9128 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9129 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9130 address.
9131
9132 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9133 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9134 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9135 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9136 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9137 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9138 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9139 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9140 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9141 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9142
9143 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9144 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9145 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9146 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9147 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9148 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9149 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9150
9151 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9152 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9153 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9154 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9155
9156 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9157 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9158 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9159 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9160 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9161 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009162 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9163 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9164 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9165 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9166 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9167 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009168
9169 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9170 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9171 the request.
9172
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009173 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9174 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009175 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009176
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009177 Example :
9178 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9179 # last 30 minutes
9180 backend pop
9181 mode tcp
9182 balance roundrobin
9183 stick store-request src
9184 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9185 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9186 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9187
9188 backend smtp
9189 mode tcp
9190 balance roundrobin
9191 stick match src table pop
9192 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9193 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9194
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009195 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009196 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009197
9198
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009199stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009200 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9201 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009202 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009204 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009205
9206 Arguments :
9207 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9208 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9209 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9210 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9211
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009212 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9213 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9214 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9215 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9216
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009217 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9218 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9219 instance.
9220
9221 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9222 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9223 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9224 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9225 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9226 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009227 to 32 characters.
9228
9229 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9230 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9231 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009232 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009233 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9234 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009235
9236 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009237 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9238 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009239 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9240 increase.
9241
9242 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009243 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9244 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9245 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009246
9247 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9248 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9249 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9250 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009251 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009252 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9253 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9254 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9255 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9256 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9257 parameter (see below).
9258
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009259 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9260 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9261 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9262 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9263 soft restart.
9264
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009265 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9266 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009267
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009268 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9269 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9270 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9271 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009272 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009273 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009274 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9275 if not expiration delay is specified.
9276
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009277 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9278 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9279 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9280 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009281 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9282 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9283 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9284 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9285 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9286 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9287 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9288 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9289 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9290 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9291 types and their arguments.
9292
9293 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9294 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9295 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9296 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9297
9298 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9299 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9300 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009301 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009302
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009303 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9304 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9305 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009306 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009307 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009308 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009309
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009310 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9311 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9312 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9313 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9314
9315 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9316 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9317 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9318 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9319 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9320 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9321
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009322 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9323 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9324 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9325 they were received.
9326
9327 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9328 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9329 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9330 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9331 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9332
9333 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9334 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9335 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9336 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9337 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9338
9339 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9340 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9341 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9342
9343 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9344 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9345 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9346 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9347 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9348
9349 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9350 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9351 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9352 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9353 the client side.
9354
9355 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9356 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9357 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9358 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9359 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9360 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9361 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9362
9363 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9364 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9365 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9366 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9367 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9368 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009369 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009370
9371 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9372 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9373 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9374 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9375 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9376 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9377
9378 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009379 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009380 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9381 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9382
9383 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9384 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9385 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9386 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9387 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9388 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9389 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9390 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9391 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9392 recommended for better fairness.
9393
9394 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009395 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009396 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9397 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9398
9399 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9400 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9401 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9402 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9403 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9404 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9405 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9406 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9407 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9408 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009409
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009410 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9411 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009412 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9413 reference it.
9414
9415 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9416 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009417 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9418 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9419 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009420
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009421 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9422 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9423 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9424 something that can be ignored.
9425
9426 Example:
9427 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9428 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9429 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9430 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9431
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009432 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009433 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009434
9435
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009436stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009437 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9439 no | no | yes | yes
9440
9441 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009442 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009443 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009444 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009445 server is selected.
9446
9447 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9448 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9449 the "stick-table" statement.
9450
9451 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9452 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9453 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9454 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9455
9456 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9457 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9458 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9459 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9460 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9461 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009462 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009463 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9464 rules.
9465
9466 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9467 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9468 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9469 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9470 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9471 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9472 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9473
9474 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9475 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9476 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9477 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9478
9479 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9480 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9481 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9482 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9483 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9484 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009485 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9486 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9487 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9488 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9489 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9490 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9491 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9492 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9493 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009494
9495 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9496
9497 Example :
9498 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9499 backend https
9500 mode tcp
9501 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009502 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009503 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009504
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009505 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9506 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9507
9508 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9509 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9510 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9511
9512 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9513 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009514
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009515 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9516 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9517 # at offset 44.
9518
9519 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9520 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9521
9522 # Learn on response if server hello.
9523 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009524
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009525 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9526 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9527
9528 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9529 extraction.
9530
9531
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009532tcp-check connect [params*]
9533 Opens a new connection
9534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9535 no | no | yes | yes
9536
9537 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9538 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9539 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9540
9541 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9542 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9543 of the sequence.
9544
9545 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9546 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9547 do.
9548
9549 Parameters :
9550 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9551 use the TCP connection.
9552
9553 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9554 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9555 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9556
9557 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9558
9559 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9560
9561 Examples:
9562 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9563 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9564 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9565 option tcp-check
9566 tcp-check connect
9567 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9568 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9569 tcp-check send \r\n
9570 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9571 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9572 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9573 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9574 tcp-check send \r\n
9575 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9576 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9577
9578 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9579 option tcp-check
9580 tcp-check connect port 110
9581 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9582 tcp-check connect port 143
9583 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9584 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9585
9586 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9587
9588
9589tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009590 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9592 no | no | yes | yes
9593
9594 Arguments :
9595 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9596 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9597 binary.
9598 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9599 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9600 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9601
9602 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9603 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9604 with the usual backslash ('\').
9605 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009606 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009607 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9608 used upper or lower case.
9609
9610
9611 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9612
9613 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9614 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9615 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9616 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9617 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9618 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9619 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9620 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9621
9622 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9623 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9624 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9625 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9626 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9627 expression.
9628
9629 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9630 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9631 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9632 this exact hexadecimal string.
9633 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9634
9635 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9636 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9637 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9638 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9639 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9640 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9641 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9642 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9643 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9644 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9645 the null character.
9646
9647 Examples :
9648 # perform a POP check
9649 option tcp-check
9650 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9651
9652 # perform an IMAP check
9653 option tcp-check
9654 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9655
9656 # look for the redis master server
9657 option tcp-check
9658 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009659 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009660 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9661 tcp-check expect string role:master
9662 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9663 tcp-check expect string +OK
9664
9665
9666 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9667 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9668
9669
9670tcp-check send <data>
9671 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9673 no | no | yes | yes
9674
9675 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9676 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9677
9678 Examples :
9679 # look for the redis master server
9680 option tcp-check
9681 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9682 tcp-check expect string role:master
9683
9684 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9685 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9686
9687
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009688tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9689 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009690 tcp health check
9691 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9692 no | no | yes | yes
9693
9694 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9695 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009696 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009697 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9698 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9699 hexadecimal string.
9700 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9701
9702 Examples :
9703 # redis check in binary
9704 option tcp-check
9705 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9706 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9707
9708
9709 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9710 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9711
9712
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009713tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9714 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9716 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009717 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009718 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9719 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009720
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009721 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009722
9723 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9724 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009725 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9726 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9727 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9728 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9729 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9730 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009731
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009732 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9733 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9734 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9735 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009736
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009737 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009738 - accept :
9739 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9740 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9741 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009742
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009743 - reject :
9744 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9745 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9746 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9747 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9748 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9749 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9750 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9751 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9752 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9753 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9754 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009755 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009756
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009757 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9758 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9759 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9760 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9761 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9762 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9763 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9764 hosts.
9765
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009766 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9767 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9768 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9769 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9770 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9771 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9772 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9773 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9774
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009775 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9776 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9777 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9778 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9779 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9780 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9781 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9782 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9783 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009784 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9785 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009786
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009787 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009788 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009789 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9790 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9791 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009792 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009793 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9794 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9795 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9796 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9797 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9798 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9799 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9800 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009801
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009802 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009803 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009804 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009805 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009806 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9807 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9808 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009809
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009810 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9811 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9812 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9813 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009814
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009815 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9816 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9817 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9818 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9819 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009820 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9821 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9822 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9823 layer7 information is extracted.
9824
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009825 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9826 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9827 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9828 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9829 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009830
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009831 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9832 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9833 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9834 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9835
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009836 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9837 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9838 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9839 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9840
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009841 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9842 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9843 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9844 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9845 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009846
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009847 - set-src <expr> :
9848 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9849 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9850 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009851 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009852
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009853 Arguments:
9854 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9855 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009856
9857 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009858 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9859
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009860 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9861 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009862
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009863 - set-src-port <expr> :
9864 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9865 expression.
9866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009867 Arguments:
9868 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9869 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009870
9871 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009872 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9873
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009874 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9875 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9876 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009877
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009878 - set-dst <expr> :
9879 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9880 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9881 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9882 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9883 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9884
9885 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9886 followed by some converters.
9887
9888 Example:
9889
9890 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9891 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9892
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009893 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9894 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9895
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009896 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9897 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9898 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9899 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9900
9901
9902 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9903 followed by some converters.
9904
9905 Example:
9906
9907 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9908
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009909 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9910 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9911 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9912
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009913 - "silent-drop" :
9914 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009915 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009916 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9917 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9918 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9919 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9920 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009921 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9922 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009923 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9924 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009925 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009926 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9927 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9928 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9929 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9930
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009931 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9932 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9933 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009934
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009935 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9936 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9937 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009938
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009939 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009940 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009941 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009942
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009943 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9944 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9945 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009946
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009947 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009948 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9949 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009950
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009951 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9952
9953 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9954
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009955 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9956
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009957 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009958
9959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009960tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9961 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009963 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009964 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009965 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9966 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009968 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009969
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009970 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009971 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9972 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9973 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9974 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009975
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009976 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9977 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9978 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9979 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009980 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9981 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9982 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9983 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9984 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9985 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009986 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009987 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009989 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9990 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9991 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9992 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009993
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009994 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009995 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009996 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009997 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9998 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009999 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010000 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010001 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010002 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010003 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010004 - set-dst <expr>
10005 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010006 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010007 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010008 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010009 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010010 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010011
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010012 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10013 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010014 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10015 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010016
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010017 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10018 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10019 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10020 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10021 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10022 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010024 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010025 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10026 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010028 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010029 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10030 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10031 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10032 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010033 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10034 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10035 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010036
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010037 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010038 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10039 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10040 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010041
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010042 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10043 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10044
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010045 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010046 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10047 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010048
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010049 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10050 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010051 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010052 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10053 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010054 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010055 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010056 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010057 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10058 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010059 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010060 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10061 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010062
10063 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10064 followed by some converters.
10065
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010066 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10067 <var-name>.
10068
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010069 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10070 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10071 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10072 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10073 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10074
10075 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10076 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10077 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10078 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10079 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10080 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10081 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10082 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10083 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10084 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10085 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10086
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010087 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10088 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10089 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10090 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10091 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10092
10093 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10094
10095 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10096
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010097 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10098 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10099 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10100 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10101 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10102 evaluated.
10103
10104 Example:
10105 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10106
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010107 Example:
10108
10109 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010110 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010111
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010112 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010113 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10114 # and reject everything else.
10115 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10116 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010117 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010118 tcp-request content reject
10119
10120 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010121 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10122 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10123 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010124 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010125
10126 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10127 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10128 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010129 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010130 tcp-request content reject
10131
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010132 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010133 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010134 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010135 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010136 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10137 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010138
10139 Example:
10140 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10141 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010142 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010143
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010144 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010145 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010146
10147 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010148 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010149 # protecting all our sites
10150 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010151 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10152 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010153 ...
10154 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10155
10156 backend http_dynamic
10157 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010158 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010159 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010160 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010161 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010162 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010163 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010165 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010166
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010167 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10168 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010169
10170
10171tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10172 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010174 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010175 Arguments :
10176 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10177 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10178 as explained at the top of this document.
10179
10180 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10181 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10182 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10183 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10184 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10185
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010186 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10187 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10188 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10189 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10190
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010191 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10192 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010193 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010194 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010195 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10196 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10197 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10198 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010199
10200 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10201 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10202 it pass through unaffected.
10203
10204 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10205 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10206 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010207 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010208 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10209 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010210 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10211 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10212 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010213
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010214 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010215 "timeout client".
10216
10217
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010218tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10219 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10221 no | no | yes | yes
10222 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010223 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10224 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010225
10226 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10227
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010228 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010229 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10230 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010231 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10232 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010233
10234 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10235
10236 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10237 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10238 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10239 inserted.
10240
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010241 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010242 - accept :
10243 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10244 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10245 the rules evaluation.
10246
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010247 - close :
10248 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10249 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10250 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10251 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10252 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10253 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010254 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010255 protocols.
10256
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010257 - reject :
10258 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10259 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010260 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010261
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010262 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10263 Sets a variable.
10264
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010265 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10266 Unsets a variable.
10267
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010268 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10269 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10270 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10271 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10272
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010273 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10274 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10275 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10276 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10277
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010278 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10279 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10280 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10281 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10282 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010283
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010284 - "silent-drop" :
10285 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010286 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010287 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10288 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10289 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10290 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10291 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010292 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10293 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010294 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10295 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010296 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010297 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10298 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10299 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10300 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10301
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010302 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10303 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10304
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010305 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10306 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10307 for changing the default action to a reject.
10308
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010309 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10310 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10311 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10312 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010313 period.
10314
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010315 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10316 declared inline.
10317
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010318 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10319 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010320 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010321 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10322 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010323 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010324 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010325 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010326 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10327 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010328 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010329 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10330 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010331
10332 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10333 followed by some converters.
10334
10335 Example:
10336
10337 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10338
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010339 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10340 <var-name>.
10341
10342 Example:
10343
10344 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10345
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010346 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10347 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10348 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10349 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10350 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10351
10352 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10353
10354 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10355
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010356 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10357
10358 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10359
10360
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010361tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10362 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10364 no | yes | yes | no
10365 Arguments :
10366 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10367 below.
10368
10369 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10370
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010371 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010372 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10373 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10374 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10375 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10376 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10377 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10378 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010379 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010380 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10381 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10382 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10383 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10384 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10385 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10386 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10387 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10388 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10389 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10390 instead.
10391
10392 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10393 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10394 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10395 rules which may be inserted.
10396
10397 Several types of actions are supported :
10398 - accept : the request is accepted
10399 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10400 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10401 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010402 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010403 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010404 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010405 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010406 - silent-drop
10407
10408 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10409 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10410 sections for a complete description.
10411
10412 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10413 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10414 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10415
10416 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10417 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10418 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10419 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10420 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10421
10422 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10423 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10424
10425 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10426 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10427 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10428
10429 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10430 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10431 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10432
10433 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10434 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10435 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10436
10437 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10438 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10439 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10440
10441 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10442
10443 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10444
10445
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010446tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10447 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10449 no | no | yes | yes
10450 Arguments :
10451 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10452 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10453 as explained at the top of this document.
10454
10455 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10456
10457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010458timeout check <timeout>
10459 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10460 established.
10461
10462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10463 yes | no | yes | yes
10464 Arguments:
10465 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10466 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10467 as explained at the top of this document.
10468
10469 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10470 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010471 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010472 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010473 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10474 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10475 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010476
10477 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10478 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10479
10480 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10481 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010482 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010483
10484 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10485 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10486 forget about it.
10487
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010488 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10489 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010490
10491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010492timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010493 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10495 yes | yes | yes | no
10496 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10499 as explained at the top of this document.
10500
10501 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10502 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10503 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010504 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10505 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10506 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10507 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010508 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10509 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10510 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010511 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010512 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010513 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10514 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010515 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10516 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010517
10518 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10519 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10520 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10521 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010522 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010523 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10524
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010525 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010526
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010527 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010529
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010530timeout client-fin <timeout>
10531 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10533 yes | yes | yes | no
10534 Arguments :
10535 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10536 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10537 as explained at the top of this document.
10538
10539 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10540 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10541 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10542 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10543 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10544 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10545 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010546 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10547 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10548 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010549
10550 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10551 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10552 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10553
10554 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10555
10556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010557timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010558 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10560 yes | no | yes | yes
10561 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010562 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010563 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10564 as explained at the top of this document.
10565
10566 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010567 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010568 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010569 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010570 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10571 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010572
10573 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10574 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10575 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10576 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010577 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010578 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10579
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010580 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010582
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010583timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10584 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10586 yes | yes | yes | yes
10587 Arguments :
10588 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10589 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10590 as explained at the top of this document.
10591
10592 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10593 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10594 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10595 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10596 once the request has started to present itself.
10597
10598 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10599 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10600 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10601 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10602 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10603
10604 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10605 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10606 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10607 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10608
10609 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10610 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010611 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010612 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10613 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010614 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010615
10616 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10617 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10618 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10619 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10620
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010621 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10622 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010623 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10624
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010625 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10626
10627
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010628timeout http-request <timeout>
10629 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010631 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010632 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010633 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010634 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10635 as explained at the top of this document.
10636
10637 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10638 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10639 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10640 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10641 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10642 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10643 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010644 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10645 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10646 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10647 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010648 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010649 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10650 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010651
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010652 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10653 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10654 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10655 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10656 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010657 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010658
10659 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10660 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010661 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010662 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10663 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10664
10665 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010666 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10667 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10668 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010669
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010670 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010671 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010672
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010673
10674timeout queue <timeout>
10675 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10677 yes | no | yes | yes
10678 Arguments :
10679 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10680 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10681 as explained at the top of this document.
10682
10683 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10684 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10685 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10686 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10687 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10688
10689 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10690 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10691 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10692 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10693
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010694 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010695
10696
10697timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010698 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10700 yes | no | yes | yes
10701 Arguments :
10702 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10703 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10704 as explained at the top of this document.
10705
10706 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10707 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10708 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10709 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10710 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10711 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10712 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10713
10714 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10715 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10716 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10717 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10718 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010719 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010720 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010721 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10722 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010723 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10724 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010725
10726 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10727 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10728 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10729 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010730 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010731 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10732
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010733 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010734
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010735
10736timeout server-fin <timeout>
10737 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10739 yes | no | yes | yes
10740 Arguments :
10741 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10742 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10743 as explained at the top of this document.
10744
10745 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10746 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10747 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10748 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10749 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10750 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10751 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10752 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10753 situations, it should not be needed.
10754
10755 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10756 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10757 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10758
10759 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10760
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010761
10762timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010763 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10765 yes | yes | yes | yes
10766 Arguments :
10767 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10768 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10769 as explained at the top of this document.
10770
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010771 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10772 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10773 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010774
10775 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10776 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10777 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10778 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010779 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010780
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010781 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010782
10783
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010784timeout tunnel <timeout>
10785 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10787 yes | no | yes | yes
10788 Arguments :
10789 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10790 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10791 as explained at the top of this document.
10792
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010793 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010794 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10795 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10796 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010797 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10798 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010799 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10800 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10801 specified.
10802
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010803 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10804 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10805 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10806 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10807 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10808 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10809 state.
10810
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010811 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10812 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10813 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10814 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010815 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010816
10817 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10818 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10819 forget about it.
10820
10821 Example :
10822 defaults http
10823 option http-server-close
10824 timeout connect 5s
10825 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010826 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010827 timeout server 30s
10828 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10829
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010830 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010831
10832
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010833transparent (deprecated)
10834 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010836 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010837 Arguments : none
10838
10839 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10840 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10841 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10842 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10843 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10844 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10845 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10846 appropriate server.
10847
10848 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10849
10850 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10851 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10852
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010853 See also: "option transparent"
10854
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010855unique-id-format <string>
10856 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10858 yes | yes | yes | no
10859 Arguments :
10860 <string> is a log-format string.
10861
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010862 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10863 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10864 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10865 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010866
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010867 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10868 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10869 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10870 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10871 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10872 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10873 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10874 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010875
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010876 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10877 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010878
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010879 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010880
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010881 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010882
10883 will generate:
10884
10885 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10886
10887 See also: "unique-id-header"
10888
10889unique-id-header <name>
10890 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10892 yes | yes | yes | no
10893 Arguments :
10894 <name> is the name of the header.
10895
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010896 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10897 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010898
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010899 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010900
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010901 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010902 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10903
10904 will generate:
10905
10906 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10907
10908 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010909
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010910use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010911 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10913 no | yes | yes | no
10914 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010915 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10916 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010917
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010918 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10919 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010920
10921 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10922 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10923 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010924 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010925 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010926 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10927 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010928
10929 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10930 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10931 assign the backend.
10932
10933 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10934 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10935 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10936 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10937 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10938 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10939
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010940 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010941 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010942 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10943 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10944 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10945
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010946 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10947 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10948 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10949 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10950 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10951 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10952 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10953 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10954 cannot be forced from the request.
10955
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010956 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010957 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10958 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10959
10960 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10961 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010962
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010963use-fcgi-app <name>
10964 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10966 no | no | yes | yes
10967 Arguments :
10968 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10969
10970 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010971
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010972use-server <server> if <condition>
10973use-server <server> unless <condition>
10974 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10976 no | no | yes | yes
10977 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010978 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010979
10980 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10981
10982 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10983 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10984 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10985
10986 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10987 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10988 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10989 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10990 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10991 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10992 matches will assign the server.
10993
10994 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10995 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10996 with the next rules until one matches.
10997
10998 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10999 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11000 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11001 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11002
11003 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11004 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11005 stripped.
11006
11007 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11008 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11009 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11010 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11011
11012 Example :
11013 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11014 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11015 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11016 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11017 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11018 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011019 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011020 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11021 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11022
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011023 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011024
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011025
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100110265. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011027--------------------------
11028
11029The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11030depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11031settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11032written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11033described in this section.
11034
11035
110365.1. Bind options
11037-----------------
11038
11039The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11040as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11041no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11042parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11043while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11044provided immediately after the setting name.
11045
11046The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11047
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011048accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11049 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11050 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11051 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11052 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11053 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11054 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11055 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11056 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11057 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011058 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11059 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11060 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011061
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011062accept-proxy
11063 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011064 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11065 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011066 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11067 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11068 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11069 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011070 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011071 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11072 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011073 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11074 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011075
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011076allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011077 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011078 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011079 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011080 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11081 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011082
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011083alpn <protocols>
11084 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11085 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11086 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011087 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011088 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011089 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11090 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11091 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11092 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11093 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11094 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11095 preference, like below :
11096
11097 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011098
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011099backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011100 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011101 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11102
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011103curves <curves>
11104 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11105 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11106 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11107 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11108 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11109 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11110
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011111ecdhe <named curve>
11112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011113 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11114 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011115
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011116ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011117 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11118 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11119 client's certificate.
11120
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011121ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11123 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11124 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11125 error is ignored.
11126
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011127ca-sign-file <cafile>
11128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11129 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11130 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11131 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11132 'generate-certificates' for details.
11133
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011134ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011135 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11136 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11137 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11138 'generate-certificates' for details.
11139
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011140ciphers <ciphers>
11141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11142 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011143 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011144 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011145 information and recommendations see e.g.
11146 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11147 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11148 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11149
11150ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11151 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11152 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11153 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11154 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011155 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11156 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011157
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011158crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11160 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11161 to verify client's certificate.
11162
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011163crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11165 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11166 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11167 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11168 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11169 file.
11170
11171 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11172 are loaded.
11173
11174 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011175 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011176 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11177 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11178 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11179 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011180 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11181 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011182 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011183
11184 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11185 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11186 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11187 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011188 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11189 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011190
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011191 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011193 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011194 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011195 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11196 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011197 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11198 clients).
11199
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011200 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11201 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11202 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11203 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11204 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11205 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11206 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11207 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11208 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11209 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11210 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11211 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11212 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11213
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011214 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11215 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11216 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11217 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11218 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11219
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011220 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11221 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11222 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11223 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011224
11225 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11226 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11227 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11228 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11229 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11230 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11231 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11232 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11233 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11234
11235 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11236
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011237 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011238 a cert bundle.
11239
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011240 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011241 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11242 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11243 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11244 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11245 provide multi-cert support.
11246
11247 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11248
11249 Filename | CN | SAN
11250 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11251 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011252 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011253 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11254 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11255
11256 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11257 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11258 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11259 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011260 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11261 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11262 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011263
11264 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11265 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11266
11267 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11268 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11269 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11270
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011271crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011273 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011274 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011275 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011276
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011277crt-list <file>
11278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011279 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11280 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011281
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011282 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11283
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011284 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11285 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011286 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011287 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011288
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011289 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11290 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11291 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11292 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11293 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11294 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11295 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11296 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011297
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011298 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011299 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011300 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11301 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11302 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011303
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011304 crt-list file example:
11305 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011306 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011307 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011308 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011309
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011310defer-accept
11311 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11312 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11313 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011314 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011315 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11316 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11317 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11318 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11319 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11320 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11321 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11322
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011323expose-fd listeners
11324 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11325 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011326 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11327 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011328 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011329
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011330force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011331 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011332 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011333 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011334 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011335
11336force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011337 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011338 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011339 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011340
11341force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011342 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011343 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011344 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011345
11346force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011347 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011348 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011349 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011350
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011351force-tlsv13
11352 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11353 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011354 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011355
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011356generate-certificates
11357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11358 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11359 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11360 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11361 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11362 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11363 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11364 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11365 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11366 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11367 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11368
11369 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11370 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011371 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011372 certificate is used many times.
11373
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011374gid <gid>
11375 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11376 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11377 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11378 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11379 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11380
11381group <group>
11382 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11383 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11384 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11385 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11386 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11387
11388id <id>
11389 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11390 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11391 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11392 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11393
11394interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011395 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11396 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11397 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11398 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11399 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11400 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011401 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11402 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11403 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11404 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11405 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11406 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011407
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011408level <level>
11409 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11410 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11411 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011412 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011413 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11414 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11415 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011416 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011417 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011418 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011419 all counters).
11420
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011421severity-output <format>
11422 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11423 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11424 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11425 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11426 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11427 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11428 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11429 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11430 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11431 rfc5424 convention.
11432
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011433maxconn <maxconn>
11434 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11435 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11436 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11437 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11438 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11439 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11440 eat all memory.
11441
11442mode <mode>
11443 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11444 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11445 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11446 UNIX sockets.
11447
11448mss <maxseg>
11449 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11450 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11451 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11452 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11453 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11454 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11455 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11456 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11457 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11458 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11459 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11460
11461name <name>
11462 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11463 page.
11464
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011465namespace <name>
11466 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11467 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11468 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11469 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11470
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011471nice <nice>
11472 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11473 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11474 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11475 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11476 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11477 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11478 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11479 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11480 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11481 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11482 one for an RDP socket.
11483
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011484no-ca-names
11485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11486 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11487
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011488no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011489 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011490 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011491 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011492 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011493 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11494 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011495
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011496no-tls-tickets
11497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11498 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11499 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011500 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11501 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011502
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011503no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011505 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011506 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011507 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011508 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11509 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011510
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011511no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011513 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011514 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011515 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011516 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11517 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011518
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011519no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011521 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011522 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011523 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011524 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11525 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011526
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011527no-tlsv13
11528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11529 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11530 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11531 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011532 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11533 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011534
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011535npn <protocols>
11536 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11537 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11538 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011539 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011540 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011541 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11542 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11543 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11544 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11545 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011546
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011547prefer-client-ciphers
11548 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11549 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11550 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011551 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11552 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11553 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011554
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011555process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011556 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011557 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011559 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11560 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11561 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11562 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011563 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011564 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11565 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11566 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11567 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11568 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011569
11570 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11571
11572 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11573 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11574 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11575 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11576 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11577 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11578 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11579 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011580
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011581proto <name>
11582 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11583 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11584 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11585 in haproxy -vv.
11586 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11587 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011588 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011589 h2" on the bind line.
11590
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011591ssl
11592 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011593 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011594 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11595 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011596 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11597 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011598
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011599ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11600 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11601 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11602 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11603
11604ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11605 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11606 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11607 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11608
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011609strict-sni
11610 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11611 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11612 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11613 See the "crt" option for more information.
11614
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011615tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011616 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011617 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11618 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011619 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011620 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11621 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11622 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11623 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11624 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11625 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11626 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11627
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011628tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011629 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011630 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11631 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11632 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11633 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11634 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11635 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11636 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011637 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11638 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11639 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011640
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011641tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11642 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011643 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11644 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11645 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11646 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11647 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11648 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11649 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11650 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11651 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11652 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011653 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11654 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11655
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011656transparent
11657 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11658 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11659 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11660 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11661 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11662 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11663 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11664 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11665 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11666 so check for support with your vendor.
11667
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011668v4v6
11669 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11670 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11671 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11672 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011673 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011674
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011675v6only
11676 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11677 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11678 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011679 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11680 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011681
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011682uid <uid>
11683 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11684 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11685 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11686 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11687 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11688
11689user <user>
11690 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11691 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11692 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11693 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11694 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11695
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011696verify [none|optional|required]
11697 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11698 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11699 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11700 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11701 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011702 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11703 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11704 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11705 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011706
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200117075.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011708------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011710The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11711which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11712arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11713settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11714after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11715Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11716address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011718 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011719 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011720
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011721Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11722keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011724The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011725
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011726addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011727 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011728 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11729 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11730 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11731 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11732 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011733
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011734agent-check
11735 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011736 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011737 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11738 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11739 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011740
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011741 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011742 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011743 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11744 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11745 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011746
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011747 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11748 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11749 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11750 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11751 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011752
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011753 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011754 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011755
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011756 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11757 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11758 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011759
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011760 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11761 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11762 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011763
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011764 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11765 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11766 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11767 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11768 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011769 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011770 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011771
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011772 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11773 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011774
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011775 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11776 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11777 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11778 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11779 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11780 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11781 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11782 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11783 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011784
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011785 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11786 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011787 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11788 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11789 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011790 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011791
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011792 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011793 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011794
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011795agent-send <string>
11796 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11797 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11798 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11799 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11800 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11801
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011802agent-inter <delay>
11803 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11804 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11805
11806 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11807 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11808 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11809 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11810 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11811 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11812 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11813 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11814 of backends use the same servers.
11815
11816 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11817
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011818agent-addr <addr>
11819 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11820
11821 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11822 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11823 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11824 hostname, it will be resolved.
11825
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011826agent-port <port>
11827 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11828
11829 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11830
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011831allow-0rtt
11832 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011833 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11834 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011835
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011836alpn <protocols>
11837 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11838 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11839 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011840 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011841 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11842 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11843 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11844 now obsolete NPN extension.
11845 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11846 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11847
11848 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011850backup
11851 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11852 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11853 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11854 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011855 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11856 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011857
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011858ca-file <cafile>
11859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11860 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11861 server's certificate.
11862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011863check
11864 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011865 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11866 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11867 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11868 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11869 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11870 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11871 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011872 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11873 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011874 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11875 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011876
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011877check-send-proxy
11878 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11879 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11880 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11881 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11882 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11883 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11884 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11885
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011886check-alpn <protocols>
11887 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11888 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11889 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11890
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011891check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011892 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011893 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11894 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011895
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011896check-ssl
11897 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11898 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11899 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11900 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011901 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011902 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11903 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011904 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011905 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11906 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011907
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011908check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011909 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011910 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11911 for normal traffic.
11912
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011913ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011914 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11915 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11916 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011917 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11918 information and recommendations see e.g.
11919 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11920 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11921 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011922
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011923ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11925 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11926 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11927 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011928 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11929 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11930 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011932cookie <value>
11933 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11934 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11935 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11936 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11937 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11938 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11939 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11940
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011941crl-file <crlfile>
11942 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11943 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11944 to verify server's certificate.
11945
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011946crt <cert>
11947 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11948 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11949 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11950 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11951 certificate request.
11952
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011953disabled
11954 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11955 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11956 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11957 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11958 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011959 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011960
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011961enabled
11962 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11963 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11964 default value.
11965 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11966 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011968error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011969 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11970 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11971 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011973 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011975fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011976 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11977 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11978 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11979
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011980force-sslv3
11981 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11982 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011983 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011984 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011985
11986force-tlsv10
11987 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011988 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011989 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011990
11991force-tlsv11
11992 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011993 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011994 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011995
11996force-tlsv12
11997 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011998 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011999 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012000
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012001force-tlsv13
12002 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12003 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012004 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012006id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012007 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12008 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12009 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012010
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012011init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12012 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12013 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012014 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012015 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12016 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12017 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12018 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12019 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12020 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12021 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12022 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12023 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012024 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012025 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12026 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12027 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12028 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12029 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12030 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012031 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012032
12033 Example:
12034 defaults
12035 # never fail on address resolution
12036 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012038inter <delay>
12039fastinter <delay>
12040downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012041 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12042 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12043 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12044 between checks depending on the server state :
12045
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012046 Server state | Interval used
12047 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12048 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12049 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12050 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12051 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12052 or yet unchecked. |
12053 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12054 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12055 | "inter" otherwise.
12056 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012058 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12059 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12060 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12061 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012062 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12063 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12064 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12065 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12066 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012068maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012069 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12070 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012071 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12072 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012073 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12074 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12075 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12076 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12077
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012078 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12079 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12080 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12081 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12082 than 50 concurrent requests.
12083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012084maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012085 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12086 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12087 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12088 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12089 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12090 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12091 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12092
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012093max-reuse <count>
12094 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12095 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12096 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12097 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12098 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12099 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12100 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12101 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12102
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012103minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012104 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12105 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12106 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12107 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12108 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12109 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012110 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012111 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012112
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012113namespace <name>
12114 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12115 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12116 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12117 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12118
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012119no-agent-check
12120 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12121 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12122 default value.
12123 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12124 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12125
12126no-backup
12127 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12128 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12129 default value.
12130 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12131 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12132
12133no-check
12134 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12135 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12136 default value.
12137 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12138 "default-server" "check" setting.
12139
12140no-check-ssl
12141 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12142 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12143 default value.
12144 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12145 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12146
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012147no-send-proxy
12148 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12149 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12150 default value.
12151 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12152 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12153
12154no-send-proxy-v2
12155 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12156 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12157 default value.
12158 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12159 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12160
12161no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12162 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12163 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12164 default value.
12165 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12166 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12167
12168no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12169 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12170 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12171 default value.
12172 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12173 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12174
12175no-ssl
12176 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12177 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12178 default value.
12179 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12180 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12181
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012182no-ssl-reuse
12183 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12184 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12185 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12186 and for paranoid users.
12187
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012188no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012189 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12190 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012191 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012192
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012193 Supported in default-server: No
12194
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012195no-tls-tickets
12196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12197 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12198 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012199 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12200 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012201 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012202
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012203no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012204 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012205 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12206 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012207 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12208 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012209 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012210
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012211 Supported in default-server: No
12212
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012213no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012214 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012215 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12216 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012217 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12218 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012219 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012220
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012221 Supported in default-server: No
12222
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012223no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012224 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012225 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12226 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012227 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12228 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012229 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012230
12231 Supported in default-server: No
12232
12233no-tlsv13
12234 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12235 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12236 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12237 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12238 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012239 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012240
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012241 Supported in default-server: No
12242
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012243no-verifyhost
12244 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12245 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12246 default value.
12247 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12248 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012249
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012250no-tfo
12251 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12252 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12253 default value.
12254 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12255 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12256
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012257non-stick
12258 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12259 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12260 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12261
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012262npn <protocols>
12263 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12264 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12265 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012266 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012267 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12268 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12269 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012271observe <mode>
12272 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12273 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12274 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12275 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12276 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12277 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012278 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012279
12280 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012282on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012283 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12284 Currently, four modes are available:
12285 - fastinter: force fastinter
12286 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12287 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12288 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12289 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12290
12291 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12292
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012293on-marked-down <action>
12294 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12295 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012296 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12297 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12298 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12299 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12300 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12301 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12302 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12303 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012304
12305 Actions are disabled by default
12306
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012307on-marked-up <action>
12308 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12309 Currently one action is available:
12310 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12311 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12312 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12313 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012314 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12315 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012316 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12317 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12318
12319 Actions are disabled by default
12320
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012321pool-max-conn <max>
12322 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12323 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12324 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12325 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12326 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12327 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12328
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012329pool-purge-delay <delay>
12330 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012331 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012332 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012334port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012335 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12336 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12337 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12338 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12339 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12340 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12341
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012342proto <name>
12343
12344 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12345 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12346 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12347 reported in haproxy -vv.
12348 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12349 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012351redir <prefix>
12352 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12353 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12354 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12355 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12356 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12357 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12358 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12359 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012360 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012361 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012362 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12363 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12364 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12365 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12366
12367 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012369rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012370 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12371 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12372 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12373
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012374resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12375 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12376 server.
12377
12378 Available options:
12379
12380 * allow-dup-ip
12381 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12382 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12383 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12384 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12385 For such case, simply enable this option.
12386 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12387
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012388 * ignore-weight
12389 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12390 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12391 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12392
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012393 * prevent-dup-ip
12394 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12395 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12396 same fqdn.
12397 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12398
12399 Example:
12400 backend b_myapp
12401 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12402 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12403 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12404
12405 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12406 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12407 it
12408 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12409 different address
12410
12411 Default value: not set
12412
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012413resolve-prefer <family>
12414 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12415 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12416 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12417 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12418
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012419 Default value: ipv6
12420
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012421 Example:
12422
12423 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012424
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012425resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012426 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012427 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012428 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012429 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12430 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012431 configured network, another address is selected.
12432
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012433 Example:
12434
12435 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012436
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012437resolvers <id>
12438 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12439 hostname.
12440
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012441 Example:
12442
12443 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012444
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012445 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012446
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012447send-proxy
12448 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12449 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12450 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12451 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012452 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12453 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12454 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12455 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12456 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12457 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12458 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12459 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12460 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12461 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012462 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12463 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012464
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012465send-proxy-v2
12466 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12467 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12468 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12469 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012470 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12471 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12472 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12473 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012474
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012475proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12476 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12477 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012478 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12479 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012480 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12481 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012482 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012483
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012484send-proxy-v2-ssl
12485 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12486 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12487 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12488 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12489 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12490 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12491 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012492 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12493 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012494
12495send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12496 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12497 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12498 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12499 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12500 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12501 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12502 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12503 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012504 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12505 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012507slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012508 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12509 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12510 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12511 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12512 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12513 parameters :
12514
12515 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12516 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12517
12518 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12519 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12520 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12521 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12522
12523 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12524 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12525 seen as failed.
12526
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012527sni <expression>
12528 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12529 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12530 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12531 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012532 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12533 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012534 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012535 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12536 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012537
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012538source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012539source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012540source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012541 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12542 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12543 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12544 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12545
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012546 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12547 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12548 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12549 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12550 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12551 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12552 server.
12553
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012554 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12555 specifying the source address without port(s).
12556
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012557ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012558 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12559 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12560 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12561 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12562 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12563 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012564 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12565 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012566
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012567ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12568 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12569 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12570 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12571
12572ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12573 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12574 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12575 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12576
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012577ssl-reuse
12578 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12579 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12580 default value.
12581 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12582 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12583
12584stick
12585 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12586 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12587 default value.
12588 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12589 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012590
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012591socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012592 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012593 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12594 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12595
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012596tcp-ut <delay>
12597 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12598 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12599 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012600 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012601 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12602 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12603 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12604 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12605 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12606 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12607 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12608 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12609 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12610
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012611tfo
12612 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12613 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12614 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12615 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12616 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012617 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012619track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012620 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12621 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12622 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12623 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012624 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12625
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012626tls-tickets
12627 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12628 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12629 default value.
12630 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12631 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012632
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012633verify [none|required]
12634 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012635 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012636 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12637 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012638 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012639 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12640 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12641 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12642 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12643 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12644 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12645 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12646 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012647
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012648verifyhost <hostname>
12649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012650 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12651 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12652 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12653 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12654 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12655 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12656 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12657 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012659weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012660 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12661 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12662 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012663 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12664 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12665 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12666 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12667 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12668 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012669
12670
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126715.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12672-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012673
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012674HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12675using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12676configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012677This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12678can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12679workload.
12680This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12681resolution at run time.
12682Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12683carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12684
12685
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126865.3.1. Global overview
12687----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012688
12689As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12690different steps of the process life:
12691
12692 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12693 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12694 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12695
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012696 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12697 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012698
12699A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12700 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12701 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12702 resolution to know this new IP.
12703
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012704When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012705HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012706SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12707from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12708will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12709will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012710
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012711A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012712 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012713 first valid response.
12714
12715 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12716 servers return an error.
12717
12718
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127195.3.2. The resolvers section
12720----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012721
12722This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012723HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12724contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012725
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012726When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12727uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12728is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12729answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12730
12731When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012732used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012733
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012734 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12735 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12736 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012737
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012738 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12739 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012740
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012741 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12742 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12743 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012744
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012745For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12746following scenarios are possible:
12747
12748 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12749 ignored
12750
12751 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12752 applied
12753
12754 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12755 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12756
12757 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12758 retries the query with a new type
12759
12760 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12761 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012762
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012763As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12764a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012765<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012766
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012767
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012768resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012769 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012770
12771A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12772
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012773accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012774 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012775 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012776 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12777 by RFC 6891)
12778
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012779 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12780
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012781nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12782 DNS server description:
12783 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12784 <ip> : IP address of the server
12785 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12786
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012787parse-resolv-conf
12788 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12789 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12790 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12791
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012792hold <status> <period>
12793 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12794 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012795 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012796 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012797 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12798 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12799 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12800
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012801 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012802
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012803resolve_retries <nb>
12804 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12805 giving up.
12806 Default value: 3
12807
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012808 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12809 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12810 type.
12811
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012812timeout <event> <time>
12813 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12814 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12815 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012816 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12817 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012818 Default value: 1s
12819 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012820 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012821 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012822 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12823 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12824
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012825 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012826
12827 resolvers mydns
12828 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12829 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012830 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012831 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012832 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012833 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012834 hold other 30s
12835 hold refused 30s
12836 hold nx 30s
12837 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012838 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012839 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012840
12841
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200128426. Cache
12843---------
12844
12845HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12846(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12847RAM.
12848
12849The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12850this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12851
12852If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12853independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12854when we try to allocate a new one.
12855
12856The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12857
12858It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12859"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12860for more details.
12861
12862When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12863replaced by "<CACHE>".
12864
12865
128666.1. Limitation
12867----------------
12868
12869The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12870
12871- If the response is not a 200
12872- If the response contains a Vary header
12873- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12874- If the response is not cacheable
12875
12876- If the request is not a GET
12877- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12878- If the request contains an Authorization header
12879
12880
128816.2. Setup
12882-----------
12883
12884To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12885the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12886
12887
128886.2.1. Cache section
12889---------------------
12890
12891cache <name>
12892 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12893 size of cache is mandatory.
12894
12895total-max-size <megabytes>
12896 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12897 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12898
12899max-object-size <bytes>
12900 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12901 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12902 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12903
12904max-age <seconds>
12905 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12906 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12907 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12908 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12909 default.
12910
12911
129126.2.2. Proxy section
12913---------------------
12914
12915http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12916 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12917 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12918 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12919 after this one.
12920
12921http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12922 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12923 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12924 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12925 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12926
12927
12928Example:
12929
12930 backend bck1
12931 mode http
12932
12933 http-request cache-use foobar
12934 http-response cache-store foobar
12935 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12936
12937 cache foobar
12938 total-max-size 4
12939 max-age 240
12940
12941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129427. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12943----------------------------------
12944
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012945HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12947The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12948these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12949but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12950data called patterns.
12951
12952
129537.1. ACL basics
12954---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012955
12956The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12957content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12958from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12959simple :
12960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012961 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012962 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12964 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012966The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12967adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012968
12969In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012971 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012972
12973This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12974Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12975and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012976an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12977conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12978as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12979are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012980
12981ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12982'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12983which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12984
12985There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12986performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012988The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12989specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12990this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012991methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12992ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012993
12994Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12995 - boolean
12996 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12997 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12998 - string
12999 - data block
13000
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013001Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13002converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13003would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13004The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13005which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13006
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013007Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13008keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13009fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13010which are summarized in the table below :
13011
13012 +---------------------+-----------------+
13013 | Sample or converter | Default |
13014 | output type | matching method |
13015 +---------------------+-----------------+
13016 | boolean | bool |
13017 +---------------------+-----------------+
13018 | integer | int |
13019 +---------------------+-----------------+
13020 | ip | ip |
13021 +---------------------+-----------------+
13022 | string | str |
13023 +---------------------+-----------------+
13024 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13025 +---------------------+-----------------+
13026
13027Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13028matching method, see below.
13029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013030The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13031 - boolean
13032 - integer or integer range
13033 - IP address / network
13034 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13035 - regular expression
13036 - hex block
13037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013038The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13039
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013040 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13041 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013042 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013043 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013044 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013045 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013046 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013048The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13049read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13050if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13051lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13052will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13053beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13054a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13055lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13056exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13057
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013058The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13059parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13060ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13061a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13062check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13063
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013064The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13065socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13066file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013068Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13069loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13070
13071 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13072
13073In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13074the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13075case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13076as well.
13077
13078The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13079sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13080do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13081methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13082is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013083obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013084followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13085default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13086that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13087string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13088
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013089The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13090By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13091string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13092resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13093server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013094waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013095flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13096function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013098There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13099sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13100be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013101
13102 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13103 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013104 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13105 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13106 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13107 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013108
13109 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13110 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013111 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013112
13113 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013114 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013115
13116 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013118
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013119 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013120 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13121
13122 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13123 binary or string samples.
13124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013125 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13126 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013128 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13129 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13130 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013132 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13133 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013135 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13136 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013138 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13139 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013141 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13142 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013143 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013145 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13146 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13147 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013148
13149For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13150request, it is possible to do :
13151
13152 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13153
13154In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13155buffer, one would use the following acl :
13156
13157 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13158
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013159On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13160possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13161
13162 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013164All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13165criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13166method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13167to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13168criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13169the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013171If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013172the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13173For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013175 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13176 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13177 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13178 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013179
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013180
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013181The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13182types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13183combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13184brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13185default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013187 +-------------------------------------------------+
13188 | Input sample type |
13189 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013190 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013191 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13192 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13193 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013194 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013195 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013196 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013197 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013198 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013199 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013200 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013201 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013202 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013203 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013204 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013205 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013206 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013207 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013208 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013209 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013210 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013212 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013213 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013214 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013215 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13216 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13217 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013218
13219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132207.1.1. Matching booleans
13221------------------------
13222
13223In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13224Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13225When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13226that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13227
13228Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13229return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13230"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13231
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132337.1.2. Matching integers
13234------------------------
13235
13236Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13237enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13238to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13239
13240Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13241matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13242lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013243
13244For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13245unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13246representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13247
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013248As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13249two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13250instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13251ranges and operators.
13252
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013253For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013254operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13255Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13256of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013258Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013259
13260 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13261 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13262 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13263 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13264 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013266For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013267
13268 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13269
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013270This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13271
13272 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13273
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132757.1.3. Matching strings
13276-----------------------
13277
13278String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13279different forms :
13280
13281 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013282 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013283
13284 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013285 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013286
13287 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13288 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13289
13290 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13291 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13292
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013293 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013294 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13295 matches.
13296
13297 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13298 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13299 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013300
13301String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13302exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13303characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13304string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13305to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013306before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013307
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013308Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13309(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13310Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13311
13312Example:
13313 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13314 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13315
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133177.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13318---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013319
13320Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13321they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13322possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13323passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13324the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013325the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13326match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013327
13328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133297.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13330-------------------------------------
13331
13332It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13333not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13334a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13335to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13336digits may be used upper or lower case.
13337
13338Example :
13339 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13340 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13341
13342
133437.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13344---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013345
13346IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13347netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13348within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013349host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013350difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13351at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13352does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13353parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013354
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013355The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13356abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13357
13358 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13359 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13360 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13361 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13362 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13363 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13364 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13365 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13366
13367Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13368192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13369
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013370IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13371Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13372trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13373IPv6 patterns.
13374
13375HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13376following situations :
13377 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13378 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13379 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13380 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13381 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13382 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13383 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13384 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13385 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13386 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013388
133897.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13390----------------------------------
13391
13392Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13393combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13394
13395 - AND (implicit)
13396 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13397 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013399A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013401 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013403Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13404indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013406For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13407"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13408requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13409is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13410
13411 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013412 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13413 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13414 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013415
13416To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13417and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13418
13419 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13420 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13421 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13422 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13423
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013424 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013425 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13426 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13427 use_backend www if host_www
13428
13429It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13430expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13431be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13432the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13433
13434 The following rule :
13435
13436 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013437 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013438
13439 Can also be written that way :
13440
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013441 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013442
13443It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13444to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13445simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13446sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13447good use is the following :
13448
13449 With named ACLs :
13450
13451 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13452 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13453 monitor fail if site_dead
13454
13455 With anonymous ACLs :
13456
13457 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13458
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013459See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13460keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013461
13462
134637.3. Fetching samples
13464---------------------
13465
13466Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13467against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13468sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13469ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13470of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13471available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13472
13473This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13474Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13475compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13476deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13477
13478The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13479matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13480method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13481indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13482
13483As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13484when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13485mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13486the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13487ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13488
13489Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13490multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13491when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013492incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13493are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013494is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13495all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13496
13497Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13498 - name
13499 - name(arg1)
13500 - name(arg1,arg2)
13501
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013502
135037.3.1. Converters
13504-----------------
13505
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013506Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13507of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13508is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13509was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013510has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013511unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13512
13513These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13514sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13515the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013516support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013517
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013518A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13519support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13520supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13521(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13522bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013524The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013525
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001352651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13527 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13528 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13529 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13530 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13531 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13532
13533 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013534 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13535 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013536 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13537 frontend http-in
13538 bind *:8081
13539 default_backend servers
13540 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13541 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13542
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013543add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013544 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013545 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013546 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13547 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013548 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013549 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13550 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13551 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13552 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013553 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013554 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013555
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013556aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13557 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13558 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13559 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13560 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13561 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13562 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13563
13564 Example:
13565 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13566 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13567
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013568and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013569 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013570 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013571 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13572 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013573 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013574 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13575 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13576 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13577 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013578 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013579 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013580
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013581b64dec
13582 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13583 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13584
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013585base64
13586 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013587 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013588 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13589
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013590bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013591 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013592 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013593 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013594 presence of a flag).
13595
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013596bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13597 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13598 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013599 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013600
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013601concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13602 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13603 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13604 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13605 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13606 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13607 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13608 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13609 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13610 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13611 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013612 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013613 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013614 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013615
13616 Example:
13617 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13618 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13619 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13620 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13621
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013622cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013623 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13624 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013625
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013626crc32([<avalanche>])
13627 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13628 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13629 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13630 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13631 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13632 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13633 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13634 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13635 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13636 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013637 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13638
13639crc32c([<avalanche>])
13640 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13641 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13642 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13643 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13644 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13645 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13646 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13647 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013648
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013649da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013650 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13651 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13652 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13653 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013654 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013655 configuration language.
13656
13657 Example:
13658 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013659 bind *:8881
13660 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013661 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013662
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013663debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13664 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13665 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13666 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13667 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13668 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13669 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13670 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13671 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13672 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13673 printable sample types.
13674
13675 Example:
13676 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013677
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013678div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013679 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13680 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013681 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013682 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13683 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013684 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013685 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13686 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13687 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13688 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013689 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013690 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013691
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013692djb2([<avalanche>])
13693 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13694 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13695 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13696 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13697 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13698 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13699 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013700 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13701 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013702
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013703even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013704 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013705 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13706
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013707field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13708 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13709 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13710 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13711 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13712 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13713 fields.
13714
13715 Example :
13716 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13717 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13718 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13719 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13720 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013721
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013722hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013723 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013724 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013725 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013726 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013727
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013728hex2i
13729 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013730 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013731
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013732http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013733 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13734 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013735 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13736 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13737 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13738 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13739 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13740 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13741 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13742 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013743
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013744in_table(<table>)
13745 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13746 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13747 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013748 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013749 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13750
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013751ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13752 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013753 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013754 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13755 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13756 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13757 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13758 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013759
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013760json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013761 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013762 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013763 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013764 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13765 of errors:
13766 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13767 bytes, ...)
13768 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13769 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13770
13771 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13772 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13773 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13774 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13775 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13776 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013777 - "ascii" : never fails;
13778 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13779 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013780 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013781 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013782 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13783 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13784
13785 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013786 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013787
13788 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013789 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013790 capture request header user-agent len 150
13791 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013792
13793 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13794 GET / HTTP/1.0
13795 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13796
13797 Output log:
13798 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13799
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013800language(<value>[,<default>])
13801 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13802 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13803 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13804 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13805 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13806 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13807 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13808 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13809 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013810 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013811 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13812 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013813
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013814 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013815
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013816 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13817 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013818
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013819 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13820 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13821 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13822 use_backend spanish if es
13823 use_backend french if fr
13824 use_backend english if en
13825 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013826
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013827length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013828 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13829 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13830 type. The result is of type integer.
13831
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013832lower
13833 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13834 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13835 type. The result is of type string.
13836
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013837ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13838 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13839 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13840 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13841 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13842 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13843 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13844
13845 Example :
13846
13847 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013848 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013849 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13850
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013851map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13852map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13853map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13854 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13855 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13856 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13857 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13858 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13859 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13860 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13861 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013862
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013863 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13864 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13865 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013866
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013867 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013868 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013869
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013870 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13871 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13872 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13873 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013874 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13875 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013876 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13877 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13878 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13879 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13880 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13881 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13882 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13883 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013884 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13885 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13886 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013887 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13888 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13889 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13890 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13891 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013892
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013893 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13894 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13895 the corresponding match text.
13896
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013897 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13898 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13899 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13900 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13901 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013902
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013903 Example :
13904
13905 # this is a comment and is ignored
13906 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13907 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13908 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13909 | | | `---------- value
13910 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13911 | `---------------------------- key
13912 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13913
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013914mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013915 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13916 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013917 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013918 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013919 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013920 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13921 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13922 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13923 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013924 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013925 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013926
13927mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013928 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013929 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13930 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013931 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013932 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013933 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013934 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13935 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13936 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13937 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013938 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013939 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013940
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013941nbsrv
13942 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13943 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13944 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13945 map lookup.
13946
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013947neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013948 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13949 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13950 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13951 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013952
13953not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013954 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013955 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013956 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013957 absence of a flag).
13958
13959odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013960 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013961 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13962
13963or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013964 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013965 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013966 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13967 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013968 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013969 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13970 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13971 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13972 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013973 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013974 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013975
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013976protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13977 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13978 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13979 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13980 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13981 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13982 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13983 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13984 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13985 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13986 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13987 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13988
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013989regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013990 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13991 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13992 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13993 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13994 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13995 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13996 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13997 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13998 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13999 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014000 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14001 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14002 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14003 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014004
14005 Example :
14006
14007 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14008 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14009 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14010 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14011
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014012capture-req(<id>)
14013 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14014 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14015
14016 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014017 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14018 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014019
14020capture-res(<id>)
14021 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14022 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14023
14024 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014025 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14026 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014027
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014028sdbm([<avalanche>])
14029 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14030 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14031 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14032 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14033 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14034 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14035 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014036 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14037 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014038
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014039set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014040 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14041 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14042 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014043 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014044 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14045 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014046 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014047 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14048 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014049 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014050 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014051
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014052sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014053 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014054 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14055
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014056sha2([<bits>])
14057 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14058 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14059
14060 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14061 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14062
14063 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14064 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14065
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014066srv_queue
14067 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14068 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14069 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14070 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14071 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14072
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014073strcmp(<var>)
14074 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14075 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14076 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14077 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14078 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14079 shorter).
14080
14081 Example :
14082
14083 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14084 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14085 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14086
14087
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014088sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014089 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14090 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014091 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014092 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14093 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014094 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014095 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14096 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014097 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014098 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14099 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014100 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014101 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014102
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014103table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14104 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14105 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14106 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14107 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14108 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14109 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14110
14111
14112table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14113 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14114 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14115 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14116 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14117 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14118 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14119
14120table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14121 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14122 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014123 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014124 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14125 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14126
14127table_conn_cur(<table>)
14128 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14129 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14130 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14131 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14132 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14133
14134table_conn_rate(<table>)
14135 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14136 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14137 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14138 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14139 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14140
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014141table_gpt0(<table>)
14142 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14143 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14144 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14145 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14146 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14147
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014148table_gpc0(<table>)
14149 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14150 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14151 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14152 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14153 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14154
14155table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14156 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14157 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14158 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14159 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14160 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14161 sample fetch keyword.
14162
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014163table_gpc1(<table>)
14164 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14165 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14166 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14167 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14168 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14169
14170table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14171 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14172 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14173 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14174 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14175 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14176 sample fetch keyword.
14177
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014178table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14179 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14180 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014181 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014182 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14183 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14184
14185table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14186 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14187 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14188 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14189 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14190 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14191 keyword.
14192
14193table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14194 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14195 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014196 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014197 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14198 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14199
14200table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14201 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14202 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14203 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14204 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14205 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14206 keyword.
14207
14208table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14209 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14210 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014211 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014212 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14213 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14214 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14215 keyword.
14216
14217table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14218 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14219 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014220 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014221 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14222 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14223 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14224 keyword.
14225
14226table_server_id(<table>)
14227 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14228 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14229 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14230 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14231 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14232 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14233
14234table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14235 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14236 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014237 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014238 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14239 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14240 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14241 keyword.
14242
14243table_sess_rate(<table>)
14244 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14245 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14246 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14247 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14248 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14249 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14250 keyword.
14251
14252table_trackers(<table>)
14253 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14254 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14255 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14256 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14257 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14258 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14259 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14260 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14261 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14262 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14263
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014264upper
14265 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14266 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14267 type. The result is of type string.
14268
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014269url_dec
14270 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14271 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14272
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014273ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014274 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014275 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14276 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14277 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014278 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14279 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14280 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14281 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014282 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014283 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14284 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014285
14286 Example:
14287 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14288 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14289
14290 message Point {
14291 int32 latitude = 1;
14292 int32 longitude = 2;
14293 }
14294
14295 message PPoint {
14296 Point point = 59;
14297 }
14298
14299 message Rectangle {
14300 // One corner of the rectangle.
14301 PPoint lo = 48;
14302 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14303 PPoint hi = 49;
14304 }
14305
14306 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14307 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14308 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14309
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014310 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14311 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014312 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014313 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14314
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014315 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014316
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014317 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014318
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014319 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014320 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14321 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14322
14323 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14324 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14325 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14326
14327 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14328 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14329 interpret the previous binary sample.
14330
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014331
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014332unset-var(<var name>)
14333 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14334 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14335 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14336 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14337 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14338 response),
14339 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14340 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14341 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14342 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14343
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014344utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14345 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14346 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14347 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14348 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14349 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14350 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14351
14352 Example :
14353
14354 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014355 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014356 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14357
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014358word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14359 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14360 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14361 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014362 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014363 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14364 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14365
14366 Example :
14367 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14368 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14369 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14370 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14371 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014372 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014373
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014374wt6([<avalanche>])
14375 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14376 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14377 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14378 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14379 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14380 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14381 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014382 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14383 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014384
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014385xor(<value>)
14386 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014387 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014388 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014389 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014390 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014391 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14392 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014393 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014394 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14395 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014396 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014397 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014398
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014399xxh32([<seed>])
14400 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14401 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14402 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14403 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14404 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14405 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14406 as cryptographically secure.
14407
14408xxh64([<seed>])
14409 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14410 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14411 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14412 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14413 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14414 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14415 as cryptographically secure.
14416
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014417
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144187.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014419--------------------------------------------
14420
14421A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14422not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14423"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14424The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14425
14426always_false : boolean
14427 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14428 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14429
14430always_true : boolean
14431 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14432 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14433
14434avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014435 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014436 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14437 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14438 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14439 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14440 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14441 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14442 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14443 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14444 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14445 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14446 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14447 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14448 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014451 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14452 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14453 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14454 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014455 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14456
14457be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14458 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14459 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14460 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14461 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14462 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014463 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14464 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014465
14466 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14467 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14468 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14471 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14472 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14473 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014474 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014475 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14476 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014477
14478 Example :
14479 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14480 backend dynamic
14481 mode http
14482 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14483 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014484
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014485bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014486 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14487 of the string.
14488
14489bool(<bool>) : bool
14490 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14491 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014493connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14494 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014495 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14497 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014498
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014499 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014500 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014501 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14502
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014503 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14504 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014505
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014506 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014507 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014508 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014509 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014510 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014511 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014512 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014513
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014514 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14515 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014516 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014517 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014518
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014519cpu_calls : integer
14520 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14521 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14522 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14523 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14524 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14525 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14526
14527cpu_ns_avg : integer
14528 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14529 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14530 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14531 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14532 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14533 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14534 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14535 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14536 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14537 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14538 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14539
14540cpu_ns_tot : integer
14541 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14542 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14543 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14544 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14545 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14546 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14547 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14548 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14549 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14550 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14551 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14552 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14553 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14554
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014555date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014556 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014557
14558 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14559 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14560 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014561 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14562
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014563 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14564 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14565 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14566 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14567 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14568
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014569 Example :
14570
14571 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14572 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014573
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014574 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14575 # millisecond granularity
14576 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14577
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014578date_us : integer
14579 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14580 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14581 from the same timeval structure.
14582
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014583distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14584 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14585 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14586 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14587 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14588 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14589 list of supported tokens.
14590
14591distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14592 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14593 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14594 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14595 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14596 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14597 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14598 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14599 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14600 supported tokens.
14601
14602 Example :
14603 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14604 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14605 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14606 # send large files to the big farm
14607 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14608
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014609env(<name>) : string
14610 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14611 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14612 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14613 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14614 certain way.
14615
14616 Examples :
14617 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14618 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14619
14620 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14621 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014623fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14624 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014625 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14626 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014627 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14628 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014629 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014630 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14631 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014632
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014633fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14634 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14635 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14636 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014638fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14639 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14640 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14641 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14642 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14643 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14644 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14645 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14646 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014647
14648 Example :
14649 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14650 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14651 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14652 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14653 frontend mail
14654 bind :25
14655 mode tcp
14656 maxconn 100
14657 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14658 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14659 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14660 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014661
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014662hostname : string
14663 Returns the system hostname.
14664
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014665int(<integer>) : signed integer
14666 Returns a signed integer.
14667
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014668ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14669 Returns an ipv4.
14670
14671ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14672 Returns an ipv6.
14673
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014674lat_ns_avg : integer
14675 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14676 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14677 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14678 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14679 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14680 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14681 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14682 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14683 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14684 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14685 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14686 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14687 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14688 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14689
14690lat_ns_tot : integer
14691 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14692 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14693 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14694 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14695 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14696 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14697 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14698 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14699 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14700 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14701 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14702 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14703 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14704 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14705 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14706 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14707 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14708 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14709 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14710
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014711meth(<method>) : method
14712 Returns a method.
14713
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014714nbproc : integer
14715 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14716 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14717 and debugging purposes.
14718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014719nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14720 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14721 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14722 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014723 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14724 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14725 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014726
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014727prio_class : integer
14728 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14729 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14730 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14731
14732prio_offset : integer
14733 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14734 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14735 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14736 set-priority-offset".
14737
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014738proc : integer
14739 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14740 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14741 debugging purposes.
14742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014743queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014744 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14745 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14746 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014747 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14748 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14749 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14750 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14751 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14752
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014753rand([<range>]) : integer
14754 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14755 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14756 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14757 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14758 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14759
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014760uuid([<version>]) : string
14761 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14762 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14763 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14766 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14767 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14768 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14769 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14770 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014771 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14772 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14773
14774srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14775 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14776 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14777 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14778 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14779 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14780 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14781 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14782
14783 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14784 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014785
14786srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14787 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14788 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14789 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014790 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014791 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14792 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14793 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14794
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014795srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14796 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14797 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14798 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14799 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14800 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14801 fetch methods.
14802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014803srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14804 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14805 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014806 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14808 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014809 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014810 overloading servers).
14811
14812 Example :
14813 # Redirect to a separate back
14814 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14815 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14816 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14817
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014818stopping : boolean
14819 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14820 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14821 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14822
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014823str(<string>) : string
14824 Returns a string.
14825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14827 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14828 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14829
14830table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14831 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14832 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14833 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14834
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014835thread : integer
14836 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14837 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14838 and debugging purposes.
14839
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014840var(<var-name>) : undefined
14841 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014842 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14843 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014844 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014845 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14846 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014847 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014848 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14849 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014850 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014851 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014852
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148537.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854----------------------------------
14855
14856The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14857closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14858methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14859sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14860TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014861the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14862counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014863"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14864used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14865can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14866Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14867table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14868tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14869currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014870
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014871bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014872 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14873 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14874 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876be_id : integer
14877 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14878 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14879
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014880be_name : string
14881 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14882 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884dst : ip
14885 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14886 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14887 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14888 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014889 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14890 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14891 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14892 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14893 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14894 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014895
14896dst_conn : integer
14897 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14898 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14899 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14900 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14901 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14902 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14903 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14904 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014905
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014906dst_is_local : boolean
14907 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14908 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14909 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14910 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014911 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014912 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14913 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14914 it only once per connection.
14915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916dst_port : integer
14917 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14918 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14919 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14920 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14921 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14922 an HTTP header.
14923
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014924fc_http_major : integer
14925 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14926 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14927 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14928
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014929fc_pp_authority : string
14930 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14931 if any.
14932
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014933fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14934 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14935 header.
14936
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014937fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14938 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14939 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14940 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14941 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14942 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14943 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14944
14945fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14946 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14947 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14948 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14949 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14950 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14951 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14952
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014953fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014954 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14955 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14956 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14957 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14958
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014959fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014960 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14961 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14962 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14963 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14964
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014965fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014966 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14967 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14968 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14969 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14970
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014971fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014972 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14973 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14974 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14975 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14976
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014977fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014978 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14979 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14980 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14981 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14982
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014983fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014984 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14985 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14986 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14987 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14988
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014989fe_defbe : string
14990 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14991 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993fe_id : integer
14994 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014995 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014996 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14997
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014998fe_name : string
14999 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15000 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15001 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15002
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015003sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015004sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15005sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15006sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015007 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15008 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15009 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15010
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015011sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015012sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15013sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15014sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015015 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15016 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15017 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15018
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015019sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015020sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15021sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15022sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015023 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15024 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015025 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15026 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15027 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015028
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015029 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015030 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15031 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015032 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15033 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15034 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015035 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15036 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15037
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015038sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15039sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15040sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15041sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15042 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15043 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15044 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15045 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15046 when a first ACL was verified.
15047
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015048sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015049sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15050sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15051sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015052 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015053 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15054
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015055sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015056sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15057sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15058sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015059 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15060 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15061 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15062
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015063sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015064sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15065sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15066sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015067 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15068 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15069 See also src_conn_rate.
15070
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015071sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015072sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15073sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15074sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015075 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015076 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015077
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015078sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15079sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15080sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15081sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15082 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15083 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15084
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015085sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15086sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15087sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15088sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15089 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15090 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15091
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015092sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015093sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15094sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15095sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015096 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15097 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15098 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015099 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15100 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15101 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015102
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015103sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15104sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15105sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15106sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15107 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15108 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15109 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15110 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15111 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15112 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15113
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015114sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015115sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15116sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15117sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015118 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015119 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15120 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15121
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015122sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015123sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15124sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15125sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015126 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15127 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15128 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15129 src_http_err_rate.
15130
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015131sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015132sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15133sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15134sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015135 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015136 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15137 src_http_req_cnt.
15138
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015139sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015140sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15141sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15142sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015143 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15144 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15145 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15146 src_http_req_rate.
15147
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015148sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015149sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15150sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15151sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015152 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015153 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15154 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15155 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15156 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015157
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015158 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015159 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15160 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015161 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15162
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015163sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15164sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15165sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15166sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15167 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15168 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15169 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15170 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15171 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15172
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015173sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015174sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15175sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15176sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015177 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15178 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15179 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015180
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015181sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015182sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15183sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15184sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015185 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15186 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15187 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015189sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015190sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15191sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15192sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015193 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015194 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15195 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15196 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015197 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015198 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15199
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015200sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015201sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15202sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15203sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015204 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15205 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15206 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15207 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15208 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015209 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015210
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015211sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015212sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15213sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15214sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015215 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15216 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15217 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15218
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015219sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015220sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15221sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15222sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015223 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15224 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015225 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015226 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15227 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015228 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15229 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15230 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232so_id : integer
15233 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15234 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15235 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015237src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015238 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015239 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15240 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15241 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015242 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15243 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15244 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015245 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15246 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15247 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15248 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15249 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15250 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15251 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015252
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015253 Example:
15254 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15255 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015257src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15258 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15259 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15260 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015261 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015263src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15264 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15265 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015266 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015267 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15270 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15271 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15272 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15273 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15274 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15275 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015276
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015277 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015278 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15279 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15280 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15281 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015282 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015283 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15284 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15285
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015286src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15287 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15288 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15289 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15290 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15291 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15292 was verified.
15293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015294src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015295 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015296 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015297 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015298 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015301 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015302 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15303 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015304 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015306src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15307 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15308 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15309 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015310 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015312src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015313 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015315 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015316 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015317
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015318src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15319 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15320 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15321 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15322 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15323
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015324src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15325 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15326 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15327 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15328 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015330src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015331 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015333 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15334 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015335 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15336 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15337 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015338
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015339src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15340 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15341 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15342 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15343 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15344 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15345 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15346 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015348src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015349 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015351 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015352 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015353 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015355src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15356 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15357 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15358 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15359 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015360 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015362src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015363 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015364 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15365 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015366 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15369 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15370 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15371 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015372 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015373 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15376 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15377 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15378 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015379 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015380 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15381 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015382
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015383 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015384 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015385 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015386 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015387
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015388src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15389 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15390 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15391 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15392 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15393 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15394 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15395
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015396src_is_local : boolean
15397 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15398 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15399 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15400 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015401 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015402 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15403 once per connection.
15404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015405src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015406 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15407 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15408 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15409 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15410 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015413 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15414 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15415 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15416 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15417 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419src_port : integer
15420 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15421 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15422 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15423 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015426 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015427 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15428 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15429 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015430 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15433 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15434 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15435 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15436 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015437 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15440 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15441 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15442 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15443 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15444 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15445 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15446 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15447 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015448
15449 Example :
15450 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15451 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15452 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15453 listen ssh
15454 bind :22
15455 mode tcp
15456 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015457 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015459 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461srv_id : integer
15462 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15463 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15464 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015465
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015466srv_name : string
15467 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15468 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15469 debugging.
15470
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154717.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15475closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15476when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15477usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015478future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015479
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001548051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15481 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15482 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15483 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15484 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15485 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15486
15487 Example :
15488 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15489 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15490 # the request.
15491 frontend http-in
15492 bind *:8081
15493 default_backend servers
15494 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15495 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15496
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015497ssl_bc : boolean
15498 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15499 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15500 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15501
15502ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15503 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15504 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15505
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015506ssl_bc_alpn : string
15507 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15508 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015509 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015510 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15511 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15512 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15513 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15514 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15515 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15516
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015517ssl_bc_cipher : string
15518 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15519 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15520
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015521ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15522 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15523 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15524 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15525
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015526ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15527 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15528 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15529 session or a TLS ticket.
15530
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015531ssl_bc_npn : string
15532 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15533 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015534 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015535 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15536 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15537 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15538 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15539 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15540
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015541ssl_bc_protocol : string
15542 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15543 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15544
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015545ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015546 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015547 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15548 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015549
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015550ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15551 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15552 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15553 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15554
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015555ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15556 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15557 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15558 if session was reused or not.
15559
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015560ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15561 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15562 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15563 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15564 BoringSSL.
15565
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015566ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15567 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15568 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15571 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15572 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15573 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15574 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15575 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15578 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15579 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15580 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15581 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015582
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015583ssl_c_der : binary
15584 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15585 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15586 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588ssl_c_err : integer
15589 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15590 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15591 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15592 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15593 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015594
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015595ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015596 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15597 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15598 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15599 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15600 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15601 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15602 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15603 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015604 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15605 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15606 LDAP v3.
15607 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15608 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610ssl_c_key_alg : string
15611 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15612 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15613 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615ssl_c_notafter : string
15616 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15617 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15618 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620ssl_c_notbefore : string
15621 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15622 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15623 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015624
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015625ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15627 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15628 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15629 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15630 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15631 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15632 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15633 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015634 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15635 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15636 LDAP v3.
15637 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15638 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640ssl_c_serial : binary
15641 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15642 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15643 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15646 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15647 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15648 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015649 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15650 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15651
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015652 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015653 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15656 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15657 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15658 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660ssl_c_used : boolean
15661 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15662 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664ssl_c_verify : integer
15665 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15666 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15667 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15668 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670ssl_c_version : integer
15671 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15672 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015673
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015674ssl_f_der : binary
15675 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15676 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15677 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15678
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015679ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15681 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15682 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15683 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015684 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15686 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15687 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015688 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15689 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15690 LDAP v3.
15691 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15692 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694ssl_f_key_alg : string
15695 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15696 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15697 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699ssl_f_notafter : string
15700 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15701 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15702 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704ssl_f_notbefore : string
15705 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15706 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15707 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015708
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015709ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15711 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15712 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15713 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15714 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15715 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15716 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15717 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015718 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15719 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15720 LDAP v3.
15721 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15722 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724ssl_f_serial : binary
15725 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15726 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15727 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015728
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015729ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15730 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15731 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15732 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15735 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15736 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15737 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739ssl_f_version : integer
15740 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15741 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15742
15743ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015744 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15745 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15746 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015748 Example :
15749 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15750 listen http-https
15751 bind :80
15752 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15753 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15754
15755ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15756 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15757 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15758
15759ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015760 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015761 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15762 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15763 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15764 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15765 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15766 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15767 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15768 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015770ssl_fc_cipher : string
15771 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15772 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015773
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015774ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15775 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15776 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015777 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015778
15779ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15780 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15781 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015782 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015783
15784ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15785 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15786 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15787 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015788 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015789 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015790
15791ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15792 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15793 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015794 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015795
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015796ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15797 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15798 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15799 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015802 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15803 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015804 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15805 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15806 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15807 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015808
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015809ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15810 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15811 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15812 wait until the handshake happened.
15813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15815 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015816 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15817 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015818 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015819 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015820
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015821ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015822 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015823 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15824 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015827 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15829 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15830 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15831 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15832 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15833 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15834 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836ssl_fc_protocol : string
15837 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15838 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015839
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015840ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015841 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015842 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15843 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015844
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015845ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15846 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15847 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15848 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15851 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15852 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15853 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15854 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015855
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015856ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15857 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15858 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15859 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15860 BoringSSL.
15861
15862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863ssl_fc_sni : string
15864 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15865 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15866 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15867 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15868 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15869
15870 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15871 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15872 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015873 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015874 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15878 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15881 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15882 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015883
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015884
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158857.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015888Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15889sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15890only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15891For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15892be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15893can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15894sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15895for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15896content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015899 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15901 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15904 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015905 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015907
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015908req.hdrs : string
15909 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15910 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15911 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15912 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15913
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015914req.hdrs_bin : binary
15915 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15916 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15917 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15918 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15919 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15920 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15921
15922 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15923
15924 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15925 str: <int:length><bytes>
15926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015927req.len : integer
15928req_len : integer (deprecated)
15929 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15930 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15931 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15932 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15933 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15934 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15935 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15936 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15939 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015940 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15941 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15942 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15943 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945 ACL alternatives :
15946 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15949 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15950 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15951 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15952 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954 ACL alternatives :
15955 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959req.proto_http : boolean
15960req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15961 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15962 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15963 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15964 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15965 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15966 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15967 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969 Example:
15970 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15971 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15972 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015973 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15976rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15977 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15978 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15979 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15980 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15981 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15982 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15983 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15986 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15987 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15988 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15989 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15990 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992 ACL derivatives :
15993 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015995 Example :
15996 listen tse-farm
15997 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15998 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15999 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16000 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16001 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16002 persist rdp-cookie
16003 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16004 # This is only useful makes sense if
16005 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16006 stick-table type string size 204800
16007 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16008 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16009 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16012 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16015rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16016 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16017 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16018 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16019 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016021 ACL derivatives :
16022 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016023
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016024req.ssl_alpn : string
16025 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16026 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16027 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16028 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16029 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16030 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016031 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016032
16033 Examples :
16034 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16035 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16036 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016037 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016038 default_backend bk_default
16039
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016040req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16041 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16042 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016043 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16044 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16045 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16046 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16047 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16050req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16051 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16052 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16053 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16054 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16055 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16056 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16057 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059req.ssl_sni : string
16060req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16061 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16062 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16063 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16064 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16065 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16066 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16067 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16068 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16069 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16070 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16071 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16072 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074 ACL derivatives :
16075 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077 Examples :
16078 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16079 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16080 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16081 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16082 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016083
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016084req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16085 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16086 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16087 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16088 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16089 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16090 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16091 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16092 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16093 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095req.ssl_ver : integer
16096req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16097 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16098 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16099 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16100 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16101 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16102 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16103 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016104 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016105 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107 ACL derivatives :
16108 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016109
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016110res.len : integer
16111 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16112 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16113 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16114 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16115 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16116 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16117 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16118 content inspection.
16119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16121 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016122 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16123 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16124 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16125 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16128 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16129 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16130 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16131 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016134
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016135res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16136rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16137 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16138 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16139 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16140 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16141 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16142 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16143 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145wait_end : boolean
16146 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16147 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016148 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016149 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16150 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016151 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16153 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155 Examples :
16156 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16157 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16158 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16161 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16162 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16163 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16164 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16165 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16166 tcp-request content reject
16167
16168
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161697.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170--------------------------------------
16171
16172It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16173This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16174data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16175its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16176HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16177content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16178to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16179more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16180response are indexed.
16181
16182base : string
16183 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16184 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16185 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16186 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16187 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16188 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16189 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16190 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16191
16192 ACL derivatives :
16193 base : exact string match
16194 base_beg : prefix match
16195 base_dir : subdir match
16196 base_dom : domain match
16197 base_end : suffix match
16198 base_len : length match
16199 base_reg : regex match
16200 base_sub : substring match
16201
16202base32 : integer
16203 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16204 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16205 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016206 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16207 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16208 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016209
16210base32+src : binary
16211 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16212 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16213 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16214 per-URL counters.
16215
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016216capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16217 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16218 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16219 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16220
16221capture.req.method : string
16222 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16223 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16224 because it's allocated.
16225
16226capture.req.uri : string
16227 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16228 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16229 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16230 allocated.
16231
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016232capture.req.ver : string
16233 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16234 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16235 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16236
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016237capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16238 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16239 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16240 The first entry is an index of 0.
16241 See also: "capture response header"
16242
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016243capture.res.ver : string
16244 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16245 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16246 persistent flag.
16247
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016248req.body : binary
16249 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16250 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16251 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16252 the first chunk is analyzed.
16253
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016254req.body_param([<name>) : string
16255 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16256 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16257 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16258 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16259 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16260 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16261 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16262 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16263 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16264 given.
16265
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016266req.body_len : integer
16267 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16268 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16269 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16270 "option http-buffer-request".
16271
16272req.body_size : integer
16273 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16274 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16275 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16276 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16277 "option http-buffer-request".
16278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016279req.cook([<name>]) : string
16280cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16281 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16282 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16283 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16284 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16285 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16286 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16287 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16288 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16289
16290 ACL derivatives :
16291 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16292 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16293 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16294 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16295 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16296 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16297 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16298 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16301cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16302 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16303 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016305req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16306cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16307 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16308 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16309 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16310 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016312cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16313 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16314 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16315 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16316 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016317 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016318 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16319 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16320 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16321 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16324 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16325 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16326 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16327 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016328 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016330req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16331 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16332 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16333 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16334 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16335 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16336 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16337 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16338 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016340req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16341 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16342 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16343 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16344 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016346req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16347 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16348 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16349 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16350 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16351 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16352 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16353 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16354 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016355 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016356 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016357 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359 ACL derivatives :
16360 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16361 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16362 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16363 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16364 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16365 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16366 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16367 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16368
16369req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16370hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16371 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16372 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16373 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16374 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16375 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16376 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16377 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16378 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16379 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16380
16381req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16382hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16383 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16384 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16385 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16386 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16387 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016388 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016389 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16390 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16391
16392req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16393hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16394 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16395 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16396 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16397 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16398 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16399 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16400 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16401
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016402
16403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016404http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16405 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16406 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16407 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16408 basic auth is supported.
16409
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016410http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16411 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16412 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16413 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16414 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016415 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16416 basic auth is supported.
16417
16418 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016419 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16420 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16421 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16422 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016424http_auth_pass : string
16425 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16426 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16427 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16428
16429http_auth_type : string
16430 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16431 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16432 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16433
16434http_auth_user : string
16435 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16436 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16437 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016439http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016440 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16441 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016442 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16443 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016445method : integer + string
16446 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16447 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16448 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16449 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16450 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16451 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16452 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016454 ACL derivatives :
16455 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457 Example :
16458 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16459 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16460 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016462path : string
16463 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16464 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16465 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16466 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16467 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016468 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016469 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016471 ACL derivatives :
16472 path : exact string match
16473 path_beg : prefix match
16474 path_dir : subdir match
16475 path_dom : domain match
16476 path_end : suffix match
16477 path_len : length match
16478 path_reg : regex match
16479 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016480
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016481query : string
16482 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16483 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16484 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16485 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016486 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016487 which stops before the question mark.
16488
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016489req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16490 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16491 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16492 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16493 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016495req.ver : string
16496req_ver : string (deprecated)
16497 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16498 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16499 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016501 ACL derivatives :
16502 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016504res.comp : boolean
16505 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16506 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16507 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016509res.comp_algo : string
16510 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16511 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16512 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016514res.cook([<name>]) : string
16515scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16516 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16517 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16518 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016520 ACL derivatives :
16521 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16524scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16525 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16526 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16527 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016529res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16530scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16531 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16532 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16533 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016535res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16536 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16537 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16538 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16539 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16540 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16541 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16542 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16543 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16544 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016546res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16547 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16548 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16549 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16550 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16551 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016553res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16554shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16555 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16556 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16557 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16558 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16559 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16560 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16561 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16562 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016564 ACL derivatives :
16565 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16566 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16567 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16568 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16569 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16570 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16571 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16572 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16573
16574res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16575shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16576 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16577 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16578 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16579 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16580 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16583shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16584 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16585 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16586 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16587 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16588 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16589 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016590
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016591res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16592 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16593 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16594 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16595 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016597res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16598shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16599 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16600 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16601 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16602 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16603 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16604 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016606res.ver : string
16607resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16608 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16609 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016611 ACL derivatives :
16612 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16615 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16616 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016617 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016618 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016620 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16621 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016623status : integer
16624 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16625 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16626 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016627
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016628unique-id : string
16629 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16630 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16631 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16632 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16633 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16634 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016636url : string
16637 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16638 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16639 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16640 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16641 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16642 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16643 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016645 ACL derivatives :
16646 url : exact string match
16647 url_beg : prefix match
16648 url_dir : subdir match
16649 url_dom : domain match
16650 url_end : suffix match
16651 url_len : length match
16652 url_reg : regex match
16653 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016655url_ip : ip
16656 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16657 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16658 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16659 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16660 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16661 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16662 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016664url_port : integer
16665 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16666 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16667 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16668 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016669
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016670urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16671url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16673 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016674 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16675 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16676 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16677 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016678 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16679 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016680 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16681 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016683 ACL derivatives :
16684 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16685 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16686 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16687 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16688 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16689 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16690 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16691 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016692
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016694 Example :
16695 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16696 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16697 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16698 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016699
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016700urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016701 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16702 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16703 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016704
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016705url32 : integer
16706 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16707 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16708 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16709 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16710 is an unsigned integer.
16711
16712url32+src : binary
16713 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16714 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16715 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16716
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016717
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100167187.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16719---------------------------------------
16720
16721This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16722used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16723purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16724There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16725or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16726any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16727for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16728
16729internal.htx.data : integer
16730 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16731 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16732
16733internal.htx.free : integer
16734 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16735 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16736
16737internal.htx.free_data : integer
16738 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16739 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16740
16741internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16742 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16743 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16744 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16745
16746internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16747 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16748 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16749
16750internal.htx.size : integer
16751 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16752 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16753
16754internal.htx.used : integer
16755 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16756 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16757 direction.
16758
16759internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16760 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16761 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16762 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16763 of the special value :
16764 * head : The oldest inserted block
16765 * tail : The newest inserted block
16766 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16767
16768internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16769 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16770 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16771 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16772 integer or one of the special value :
16773 * head : The oldest inserted block
16774 * tail : The newest inserted block
16775 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16776
16777internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16778 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16779 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16780 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16781 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16782
16783 * head : The oldest inserted block
16784 * tail : The newest inserted block
16785 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16786
16787internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16788 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16789 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16790 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16791 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16792
16793 * head : The oldest inserted block
16794 * tail : The newest inserted block
16795 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16796
16797internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16798 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16799 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16800 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16801 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16802
16803 * head : The oldest inserted block
16804 * tail : The newest inserted block
16805 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16806
16807internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16808 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16809 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16810 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16811 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16812
16813 * head : The oldest inserted block
16814 * tail : The newest inserted block
16815 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16816
16817internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16818 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16819 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16820 it returns false.
16821
16822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200168237.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016824---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016826Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16827every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016828order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016830ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16831---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016832FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016833HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016834HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16835HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016836HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16837HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16838HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16839HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16840LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016841METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016842METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016843METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16844METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16845METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16846METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016847METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016848METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016849RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016850REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016851TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016852WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16853---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016854
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168568. Logging
16857----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016858
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016859One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16860provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16861very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16862provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16863state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016864to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016865headers.
16866
16867In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16868about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16869send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16870
16871 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16872 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16873 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16874 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16875 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016876 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016877 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016878
16879The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16880allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16881as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16882while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16883real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16884delay.
16885
16886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168878.1. Log levels
16888---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016889
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016890TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016891source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016892HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16893in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16894track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16895syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16896about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016897
16898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168998.2. Log formats
16900----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016901
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016902HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016903and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16904slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16905options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016906
16907 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16908 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16909 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16910 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16911 extents.
16912
16913 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16914 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16915 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16916 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16917 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16918
16919 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16920 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16921 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16922 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16923 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16924
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016925 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16926 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16927 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16928 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16929
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016930 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16931
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016932Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16933specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16934field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16935servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16936always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16937identifier.
16938
16939Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16940 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16941 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16942 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16943 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16944
16945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169468.2.1. Default log format
16947-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016948
16949This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16950as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16951format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16952
16953 Example :
16954 listen www
16955 mode http
16956 log global
16957 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16958
16959 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16960 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16961 (www/HTTP)
16962
16963 Field Format Extract from the example above
16964 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16965 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16966 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16967 4 'to' to
16968 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16969 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16970
16971Detailed fields description :
16972 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16973 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16974 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16975 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16976 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16977 and processed the connection.
16978 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16979
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016980In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16981"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16982connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16983
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016984It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16985will eventually disappear.
16986
16987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169888.2.2. TCP log format
16989---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016990
16991The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16992is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16993information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16994counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16995emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16996environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16997the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16998sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016999specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17000not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17001fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17002marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017003
17004 Example :
17005 frontend fnt
17006 mode tcp
17007 option tcplog
17008 log global
17009 default_backend bck
17010
17011 backend bck
17012 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17013
17014 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17015 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17016 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17017
17018 Field Format Extract from the example above
17019 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17020 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17021 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17022 4 frontend_name fnt
17023 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17024 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17025 7 bytes_read* 212
17026 8 termination_state --
17027 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17028 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17029
17030Detailed fields description :
17031 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017032 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17033 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17034 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017035 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017036 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017037 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017038
17039 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017040 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17041 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17042 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017043
17044 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17045 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17046 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017047 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17048 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17049 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17050 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017051
17052 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17053 and processed the connection.
17054
17055 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17056 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17057 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17058 applications.
17059
17060 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17061 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17062 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17063 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17064 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17065
17066 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17067 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17068 See "Timers" below for more details.
17069
17070 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17071 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17072 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17073 "Timers" below for more details.
17074
17075 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017076 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017077 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17078 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17079 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17080 details.
17081
17082 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17083 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17084 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17085 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17086 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17087
17088 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17089 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17090 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17091 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17092 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17093 for more details.
17094
17095 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017096 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017097 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17098 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17099 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017100 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017101
17102 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17103 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17104 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17105 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17106 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17107 caused by a denial of service attack.
17108
17109 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17110 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17111 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17112 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17113 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17114 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17115 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17116 denial of service attack.
17117
17118 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17119 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17120 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17121 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17122 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17123 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17124 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17125 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17126 be processed than on other servers.
17127
17128 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17129 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17130 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17131 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17132 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17133 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17134 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17135 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17136 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17137 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17138 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17139 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17140 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17141
17142 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17143 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17144 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17145 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17146 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17147 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017148 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017149 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17150
17151 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17152 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17153 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17154 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17155 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17156 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017157 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017158 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17159 occurs.
17160
17161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171628.2.3. HTTP log format
17163----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017164
17165The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17166is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17167the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17168are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17169emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17170generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17171"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17172which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017173frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17174is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017175
17176Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17177slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17178with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17179
17180 Example :
17181 frontend http-in
17182 mode http
17183 option httplog
17184 log global
17185 default_backend bck
17186
17187 backend static
17188 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17189
17190 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17191 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17192 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017193 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017194
17195 Field Format Extract from the example above
17196 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17197 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017198 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017199 4 frontend_name http-in
17200 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017201 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017202 7 status_code 200
17203 8 bytes_read* 2750
17204 9 captured_request_cookie -
17205 10 captured_response_cookie -
17206 11 termination_state ----
17207 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17208 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17209 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17210 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17211 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017212
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017213Detailed fields description :
17214 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017215 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17216 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17217 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017218 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017219 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017220 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017221
17222 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017223 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17224 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17225 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017226
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017227 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17228 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017229
17230 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17231 and processed the connection.
17232
17233 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17234 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17235 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17236
17237 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17238 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17239 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17240 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17241 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17242 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17243
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017244 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17245 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17246 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017247 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017248 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17249 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017250 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17251 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017252
17253 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17254 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017255 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017256
17257 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17258 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017259 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17260 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017261
17262 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17263 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17264 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17265 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17266 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017267 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17268 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017269
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017270 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17271 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17272 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17273 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17274 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17275 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17276 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017277 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017278
17279 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17280 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17281 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17282
17283 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17284 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017285 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017286 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17287 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17288 overflowing.
17289
17290 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17291 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17292 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17293 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17294 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17295 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17296 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17297 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17298
17299 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17300 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17301 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17302 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17303 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17304 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17305 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17306 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17307
17308 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17309 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17310 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17311 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17312 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17313 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17314 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17315
17316 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017317 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017318 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17319 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17320 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017321 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017322 system.
17323
17324 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17325 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17326 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17327 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17328 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17329 caused by a denial of service attack.
17330
17331 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17332 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17333 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17334 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17335 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17336 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17337 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17338 denial of service attack.
17339
17340 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17341 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17342 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17343 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17344 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17345 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17346 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17347 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17348 processed than on other servers.
17349
17350 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17351 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17352 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17353 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17354 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17355 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17356 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17357 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17358 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17359 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17360 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17361 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17362 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17363
17364 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17365 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17366 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17367 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17368 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17369 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017370 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017371 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17372
17373 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17374 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17375 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17376 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17377 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17378 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017379 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017380 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17381 occurs.
17382
17383 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17384 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17385 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17386 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17387 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17388 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17389 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17390 cookies" below for more details.
17391
17392 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17393 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17394 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17395 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17396 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17397 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17398 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17399 and cookies" below for more details.
17400
17401 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17402 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17403 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17404 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17405 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17406 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17407 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17408 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17409
17410
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200174118.2.4. Custom log format
17412------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017413
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017414The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017415mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017416
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017417HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017418Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17419separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17420prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17421
17422Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17423variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017424("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017425
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017426If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017427as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017428less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17429the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17430
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017431Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017432In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017433in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017434
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017435Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17436'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17437https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17438such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17439
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017440Flags are :
17441 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017442 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017443 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17444 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017445
17446 Example:
17447
17448 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17450
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017451 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17452
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017453At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17454
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017455 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17456 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017457
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017458the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017459
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017460 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17461 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17462 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017463
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017464and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17465
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017466 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17467 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017468
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017469Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17470
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017471 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017472 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017473 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17474 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17475 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017476 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17477 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17478 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017479 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017480 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17481 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017482 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017483 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17484 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017485 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017486 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017487 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017488 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017489 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017490 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017491 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017492 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17493 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17494 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17495 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17496 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017497 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017498 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17499 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017500 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017501 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17502 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017503 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17504 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17505 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017506 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017507 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17508 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017509 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017510 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17511 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17512 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017513 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017514 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017515 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17516 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17517 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17518 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017519 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017520 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017521 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017522 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017523 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017524 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017525 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17526 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17527 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017528 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017529 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17530 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017531 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017532 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17533 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017534 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017535 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017536 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017537 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017538
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017539 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017540
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017541
175428.2.5. Error log format
17543-----------------------
17544
17545When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17546protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17547By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17548"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017549will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017550logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17551
17552The format looks like this :
17553
17554 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17555 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17556 Connection error during SSL handshake
17557
17558 Field Format Extract from the example above
17559 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17560 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17561 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17562 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17563 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17564
17565These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17566failures.
17567
17568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175698.3. Advanced logging options
17570-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017571
17572Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17573just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17574options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17575for more information about their usage.
17576
17577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175788.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17579------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017580
17581It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17582haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17583commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17584monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17585ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17586
17587 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17588 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17589 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17590 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17591
17592 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17593 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17594 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017595 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017596 such as other load-balancers.
17597
17598 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17599 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17600 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17601
17602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17604----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017605
17606The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17607what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17608or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017609"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017610just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17611log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17612after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17613is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17614with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17615with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17616
17617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176188.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17619------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017620
17621Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17622for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17623"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17624retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17625raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17626a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17627file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17628you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17629"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17630
17631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176328.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17633--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017634
17635Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17636multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17637them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17638"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17639logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17640error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17641and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17642too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17643useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17644alternative.
17645
17646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176478.4. Timing events
17648------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017649
17650Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17651reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17652the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17653frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017654mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17655addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17656
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017657Timings events in HTTP mode:
17658
17659 first request 2nd request
17660 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17661 t tr t tr ...
17662 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17663 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17664 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17665 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17666 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17667
17668Timings events in TCP mode:
17669
17670 TCP session
17671 |<----------------->|
17672 t t
17673 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17674 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17675 |<------ Tt ------->|
17676
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017677 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017678 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017679 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17680 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17681 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017682 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017683 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17684 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17685 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17686 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017687
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017688 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17689 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17690 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017691 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17692 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17693 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17694 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17695 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17696 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017697
17698 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17699 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17700 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17701 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17702 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17703 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17704 request typed by hand during a test.
17705
17706 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17707 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017708 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017709 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17710 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17711 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17712 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017713
17714 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17715 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17716 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17717 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17718 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17719
17720 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17721 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17722 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17723 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17724 connection never established.
17725
17726 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17727 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17728 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17729 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17730 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17731 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17732 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17733 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17734 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17735 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17736 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17737
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017738 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17739 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17740 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17741 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17742 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17743 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17744
17745 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17746
17747 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17748 "Ta" can never be negative.
17749
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017750 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17751 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017752 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17753 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017754 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017755
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017756 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017757
17758 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017759 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17760 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017761
17762These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17763protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17764that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017765due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17766"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17767that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017768
17769Most common cases :
17770
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017771 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17772 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17773 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17774 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17775 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17776 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17777 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17778 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17779 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17780 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17781 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017782 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017783
17784 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17785 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17786 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17787 of ms on remote networks.
17788
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017789 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17790 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17791 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017792
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017793 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17794 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17795 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17796 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17797 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17798 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17799 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17800 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17801 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017802
17803Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17804
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017805 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017806 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017807 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017808
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017809 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017810 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17811 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17812
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017813 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017814 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17815 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17816 flags.
17817
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017818 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17819 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017820 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17821 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17822 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17823 the client connection was maintained open.
17824
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017825 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017826 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017827 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017828 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17829
17830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178318.5. Session state at disconnection
17832-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017833
17834TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17835"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
178362-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17837each of which has a special meaning :
17838
17839 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17840 session to terminate :
17841
17842 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17843
17844 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17845 server explicitly refused it.
17846
17847 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17848 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17849 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17850 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017851 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017852
17853 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17854 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017855
17856 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17857 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17858 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17859 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17860 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17861
17862 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17863 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17864 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17865 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17866 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17867
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017868 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17869 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17870
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017871 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17872 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17873 backup connections when going up.
17874
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017875 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17876
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017877 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17878 send or receive data.
17879
17880 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17881 send or receive data.
17882
17883 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17884 with nothing left in the buffers.
17885
17886 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17887
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017888 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017889 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17890
17891 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17892 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17893 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17894 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17895 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17896
17897 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17898 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17899
17900 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17901 server (HTTP only).
17902
17903 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17904
17905 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17906 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17907 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17908
17909 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17910 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17911 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17912
17913 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17914
17915 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17916 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17917
17918 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17919 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17920 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17921
17922 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17923 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017924 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17925 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017926
17927 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17928 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17929 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17930 another server.
17931
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017932 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017933 server.
17934
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017935 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17936 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17937 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17938 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17939
17940 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17941 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17942 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17943 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17944
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017945 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17946 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17947 "use-server" rule).
17948
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017949 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17950
17951 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17952 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17953
17954 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17955
17956 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17957 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17958 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17959
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017960 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17961 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017962 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017963 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17964 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17965
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017966 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17967
17968 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17969 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17970
17971 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17972
17973 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17974
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017975The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17976was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017977helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17978starvation, attacks, etc...
17979
17980The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17981alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17982easier finding and understanding.
17983
17984 Flags Reason
17985
17986 -- Normal termination.
17987
17988 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17989 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17990 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17991 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17992
17993 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17994 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17995 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17996 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17997 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17998 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017999
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018000 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18001 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018002 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018003
18004 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18005 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18006 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18007
18008 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18009 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18010 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18011 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18012 the server takes too long to respond.
18013
18014 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18015 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18016 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18017 long a time to respond.
18018
18019 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18020 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18021 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18022 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018023 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18024 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018025
18026 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18027 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18028 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18029 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18030 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018031 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018032 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18033 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18034 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18035 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18036 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18037 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18038 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18039 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018040 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018041 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18042 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18043 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018044
18045 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18046 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018047 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18048 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18049 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18050 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018051
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018052 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18053 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018055 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018056 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18057 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018058 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018059 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18060 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18061
18062 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18063 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18064 503 or 504 here.
18065
18066 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18067 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18068 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18069 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18070 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18071
18072 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18073 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018074 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018075 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18076 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18077
18078 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18079 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18080 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18081 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18082 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18083 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18084 between haproxy and the server.
18085
18086 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18087 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18088 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18089 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18090 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18091 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18092 solution is to fix the application.
18093
18094 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18095 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18096 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18097 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18098 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18099 external attacks.
18100
18101 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18102 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018103 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018104 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18105 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18106
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018107 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18108 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18109 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018110 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018111 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018112
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018113 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18114 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18115 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18116 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018117 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18118 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18119 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18120 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18121 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018122
18123 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18124 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18125 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18126 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18127
18128 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18129 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18130 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18131 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18132
18133 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18134 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18135 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18136 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18137
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018138The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18139persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18140important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18141re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18142
18143 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18144
18145 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18146 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18147 set on a GET request.
18148
18149 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18150 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018151 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018152 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18153
18154 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18155 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18156 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18157
18158 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18159 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18160 already got a cookie.
18161
18162 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18163 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18164 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18165 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18166 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18167
18168 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18169 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18170 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18171
18172 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18173 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18174 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18175
18176 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18177 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18178
18179 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18180 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18181 then advertised in the response.
18182
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181848.6. Non-printable characters
18185-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018186
18187In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18188consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18189converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18190prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18191being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18192escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18193is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18194'}' when logging headers.
18195
18196Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18197issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18198containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18199
18200Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18201the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18202performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18203
18204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182058.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18206---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018207
18208Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18209achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018210section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018211cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18212the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18213the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018214locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018215not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18216user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18217a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18218wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18219
18220 Examples :
18221 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18222 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18223
18224 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18225 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18226
18227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182288.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18229---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018230
18231Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18232proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18233the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18234server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18235
18236Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18237response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018238section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018239
18240It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018241time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18242appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018243are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18244and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18245follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18246request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18247in the logs.
18248
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018249As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18250frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18251an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18252
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018253 Example :
18254 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18255 listen proxy-out
18256 mode http
18257 option httplog
18258 option logasap
18259 log global
18260 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18261
18262 # log the name of the virtual server
18263 capture request header Host len 20
18264
18265 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18266 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18267
18268 # log the beginning of the referrer
18269 capture request header Referer len 20
18270
18271 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18272 capture response header Server len 20
18273
18274 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18275 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18276
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018277 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018278 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18279
18280 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18281 capture response header Via len 20
18282
18283 # log the URL location during a redirection
18284 capture response header Location len 20
18285
18286 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18287 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18288 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18289 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18290 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18291
18292 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18293 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18294 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18295 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018296 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018297
18298 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18299 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18300 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18301 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18302 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018303 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018304
18305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183068.9. Examples of logs
18307---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018308
18309These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18310them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18311reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18312
18313 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18314 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18315 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18316
18317 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18318 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18319
18320 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18321 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18322 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18323
18324 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18325 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18326
18327 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18328 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18329 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18330
18331 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018332 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018333 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18334 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18335
18336 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18337 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18338 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18339
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018340 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18341 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18342 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18343 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18344 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18345 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018346
18347 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018348 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018349
18350 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18351 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18352 Nothing was sent to any server.
18353
18354 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18355 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18356
18357 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18358 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018359 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018360 send a 408 return code to the client.
18361
18362 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18363 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18364
18365 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18366 5 seconds ("c----").
18367
18368 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18369 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018370 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018371
18372 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018373 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018374 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18375 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18376 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18377 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18378 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018379
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018380
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200183819. Supported filters
18382--------------------
18383
18384Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18385accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18386unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18387
18388See also : "filter"
18389
183909.1. Trace
18391----------
18392
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018393filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018394
18395 Arguments:
18396 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18397 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18398
18399 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18400 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18401 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18402 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18403
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018404 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018405 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18406 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18407 amount of the parsed data.
18408
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018409 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018410
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018411This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18412callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18413information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18414filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18415
18416Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18417tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18418a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18419
18420
184219.2. HTTP compression
18422---------------------
18423
18424filter compression
18425
18426The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18427keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018428when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18429fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18430done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18431explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18432filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18433listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18434order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018435
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018436See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18437 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018438
18439
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200184409.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18441--------------------------------------------
18442
18443filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18444
18445 Arguments :
18446
18447 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18448 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18449 parsed.
18450
18451 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18452 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18453 part must be placed in its own scope.
18454
18455The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18456external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018457streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018458exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18459also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18460
18461SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18462the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18463
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018464For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018465"doc/SPOE.txt".
18466
18467Important note:
18468 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18469 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18470
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100184719.4. Cache
18472----------
18473
18474filter cache <name>
18475
18476 Arguments :
18477
18478 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18479
18480The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18481"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018482cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018483other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18484case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18485is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18486filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018487listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18488order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018489
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018490See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18491 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18492
18493
184949.5. Fcgi-app
18495-------------
18496
18497filter fcg-app <name>
18498
18499 Arguments :
18500
18501 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18502
18503The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18504request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18505reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18506used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18507implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18508used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18509fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18510used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18511order.
18512
18513See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18514 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18515
18516
1851710. FastCGI applications
18518-------------------------
18519
18520HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18521feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18522the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18523FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18524servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18525FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18526backend.
18527
18528HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18529application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18530connection.
18531
1853210.1. Setup
18533-----------
18534
1853510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18536--------------------------
18537
18538fcgi-app <name>
18539 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18540 document root must be defined.
18541
18542acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18543 Declare or complete an access list.
18544
18545 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18546 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18547 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18548 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18549 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18550
18551docroot <path>
18552 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18553 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18554 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18555
18556index <script-name>
18557 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18558 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18559 is an optional setting.
18560
18561 Example :
18562 index index.php
18563
18564log-stderr global
18565log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18566 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18567 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18568
18569 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18570 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18571
18572pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18573 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18574 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18575 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18576
18577 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18578 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18579 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18580 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18581
18582 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18583 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18584
18585path-info <regex>
18586 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18587 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18588 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18589 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18590 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18591
18592 Example :
18593 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18594
18595option get-values
18596no option get-values
18597 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18598
18599 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18600 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18601
18602 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18603 application will accept.
18604
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018605 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18606 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018607
18608 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18609 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18610 option is disabled.
18611
18612 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18613 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18614 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18615 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18616 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18617 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18618
18619option keep-conn
18620no option keep-conn
18621 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18622 sending a response.
18623
18624 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18625 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18626
18627option max-reqs <reqs>
18628 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18629 accept.
18630
18631 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18632 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18633 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18634 to 1.
18635
18636option mpxs-conns
18637no option mpxs-conns
18638 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18639
18640 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18641 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18642
18643set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18644 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18645 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18646 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18647 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18648
18649 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18650 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18651 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18652
18653 Example :
18654 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18655 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18656
18657 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18658
18659
1866010.1.2. Proxy section
18661---------------------
18662
18663use-fcgi-app <name>
18664 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18665
18666 Arguments :
18667 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18668
18669 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18670 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18671 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18672 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18673 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18674
18675 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18676 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18677 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18678 application are evaluated.
18679
18680
1868110.1.3. Example
18682---------------
18683
18684 frontend front-http
18685 mode http
18686 bind *:80
18687 bind *:
18688
18689 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18690 default_backend back-static
18691
18692 backend back-static
18693 mode http
18694 server www A.B.C.D:80
18695
18696 backend back-dynamic
18697 mode http
18698 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18699 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18700
18701 fcgi-app php-fpm
18702 log-stderr global
18703 option keep-conn
18704
18705 docroot /var/www/my-app
18706 index index.php
18707 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18708
18709
1871010.2. Default parameters
18711------------------------
18712
18713A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18714the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18715scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18716applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18717
18718 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18719 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18720 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18721 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18722 | | |
18723 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18724 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18725 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18726 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18727 | | application. |
18728 | | |
18729 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18730 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18731 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18732 | | |
18733 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18734 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18735 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18736 | | the application's configuration. |
18737 | | |
18738 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18739 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18740 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18741 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18742 | | |
18743 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18744 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18745 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18746 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18747 | | be defined. |
18748 | | |
18749 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18750 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18751 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18752 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18753 | | is not set too. |
18754 | | |
18755 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18756 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18757 | | set. |
18758 | | |
18759 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18760 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18761 | | the request. |
18762 | | |
18763 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18764 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18765 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18766 | | |
18767 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18768 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18769 | | script to process the request. |
18770 | | |
18771 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18772 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18773 | | |
18774 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18775 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18776 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18777 | | |
18778 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18779 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18780 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18781 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18782 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18783 | | |
18784 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18785 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18786 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18787 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18788 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18789 | | side. |
18790 | | |
18791 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18792 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18793 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18794 | | connected to. |
18795 | | |
18796 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18797 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18798 | | |
18799 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18800 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18801 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18802 | | |
18803 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18804
18805
1880610.3. Limitations
18807------------------
18808
18809The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18810way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18811during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18812establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18813application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18814or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18815message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18816these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18817and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18818
18819Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18820request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18821requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18822
18823About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18824into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18825fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18826"http-request" ones.
18827
18828Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18829FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18830processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18831must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18832here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018834/*
18835 * Local variables:
18836 * fill-column: 79
18837 * End:
18838 */